blob: 58aaaf0621f7eaae06bd62bd0d5e93316f867c5d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
666ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
668 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300669 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100670 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
671 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
672 information.
673
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100674ssl-server-verify [none|required]
675 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
676 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
677 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
678
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200679stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
680 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
681 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
682 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
683 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200684
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200685 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
686 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
687 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200688
689stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
690 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
691 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100692 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200693
694stats maxconn <connections>
695 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
696 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698uid <number>
699 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
700 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
701 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
702 one. See also "gid" and "user".
703
704ulimit-n <number>
705 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
706 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
707 option.
708
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100709unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
710 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
711
712 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
713 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
714 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
715 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
716 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
717 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
718 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
719 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
720 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
721 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723user <user name>
724 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
725 See also "uid" and "group".
726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200727node <name>
728 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
729
730 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
731 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
732 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
733 traffic.
734
735description <text>
736 Add a text that describes the instance.
737
738 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
739 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
740 "<" and ">" characters.
741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744-----------------------
745
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200746max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
747 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
748 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
749 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
750 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
751 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
752 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
753 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
754 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756maxconn <number>
757 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
758 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
759 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200760 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
761 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
762 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
763 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
764 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200766maxconnrate <number>
767 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
768 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
769 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
770 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
771 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
772 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
773 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
774 fairness.
775
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100776maxcomprate <number>
777 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300778 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100779 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
780 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
781 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
782 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
783 default value.
784
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100785maxcompcpuusage <number>
786 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
787 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
788 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
789 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
790 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
791 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
792 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
793 process down and from introducing high latencies.
794
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100795maxpipes <number>
796 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
797 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
798 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
799 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
800 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
801 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
802
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200803maxsessrate <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
805 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
806 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
807 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
808 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
809 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
810 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
811 fairness.
812
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200813maxsslconn <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
815 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
816 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
817 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
818 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
819 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
820 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
821
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200822maxsslrate <number>
823 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
824 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
825 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
826 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
827 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
828 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
829 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
830 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
831 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
832 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
833
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100834maxzlibmem <number>
835 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
836 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
837 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100838 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
839 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
840 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842noepoll
843 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
844 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100845 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846
847nokqueue
848 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
849 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
850 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
851
852nopoll
853 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
854 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100855 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100856 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100858nosplice
859 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
860 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
861 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100862 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100863 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
864 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
865 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
866 "option splice-response".
867
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300868nogetaddrinfo
869 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
870 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
871
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200872spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900873 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
874 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
875 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
876 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
877 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
878 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200879
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200880tune.bufsize <number>
881 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
882 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
883 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
884 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
885 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
886 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
887 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
888 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400889 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
890 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
891 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200892
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200893tune.chksize <number>
894 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
895 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
896 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
897 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
898 checks whenever possible.
899
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100900tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
901 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
902 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
903 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
904 this value. The default value is 1.
905
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100906tune.http.cookielen <number>
907 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
908 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
909 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
910 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
911 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
912 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
913 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
914 to change this value.
915
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200916tune.http.maxhdr <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
918 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
919 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
920 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
921 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
922 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
923 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
924 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
925 limit too high.
926
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100927tune.idletimer <timeout>
928 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
929 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
930 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
931 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
932 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
933 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
934 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
935 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
936 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
937
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100938tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100939 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
940 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
941 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
942 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
943 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
944 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
945 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
946 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
947 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
948 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100949
950tune.maxpollevents <number>
951 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
952 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
953 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
954 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
955 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
956
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200957tune.maxrewrite <number>
958 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
959 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
960 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
961 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
962 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
963 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
964 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
965 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
966 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
967 bufsize.
968
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200969tune.pipesize <number>
970 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
971 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
972 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
973 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
974 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
975 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
976
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100977tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
978tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
979 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
980 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
981 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
982 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
983 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
984 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
985 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
986
987tune.sndbuf.client <number>
988tune.sndbuf.server <number>
989 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
990 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
991 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
992 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
993 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
994 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
995 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
996 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
997 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
998 notifying haproxy again.
999
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001000tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001001 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1002 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1003 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001004 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001005 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1006 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1007 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1008 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1009 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001010 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1011 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001012
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001013tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1014 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1015 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1016 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1017 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1018 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1019 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1020
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001021tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1022 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001023 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001024 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1025 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1026 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1027 being used for too long.
1028
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001029tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1030 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1031 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1032 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1033 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1034 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1035 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1036 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1037 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1038 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1039 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001040 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1041 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001042
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001043tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1044 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1045 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1046 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1047 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1048 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1049 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1050 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1051 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1052
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001053tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1054 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001055 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001056 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1057 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1058 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1059
1060tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1061 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1062 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1063 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1064 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010663.3. Debugging
1067--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069debug
1070 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1071 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1072 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1073 system startup.
1074
1075quiet
1076 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1077 line argument "-q".
1078
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010803.4. Userlists
1081--------------
1082It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1083http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1084it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1085
1086userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001087 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1089
1090group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001091 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001092 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1093 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1094
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001095user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1096 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001097 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1098 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1100 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001101 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001102 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001103
1104
1105 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001106 userlist L1
1107 group G1 users tiger,scott
1108 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001110 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1111 user scott insecure-password elgato
1112 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001113
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L2
1115 group G1
1116 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
1122 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001124
11253.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001126----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1128haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1129pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1130identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1131or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1132Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1133known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1134the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1135process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1136during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1137tables.
1138
1139peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001140 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001141 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1142
1143peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1144 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1145 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1146 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1147 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1148 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1149 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1150
1151 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1152 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1153
1154 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1155 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1156 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1157 across all peers.
1158
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001159 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1160 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1161 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1162
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001163 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001164 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001165 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1166 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1167 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001168
1169 backend mybackend
1170 mode tcp
1171 balance roundrobin
1172 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1173 stick on src
1174
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001177
1178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001181
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001182Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1183 - defaults <name>
1184 - frontend <name>
1185 - backend <name>
1186 - listen <name>
1187
1188A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1189its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1190section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001191section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001192
1193A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1194connections.
1195
1196A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1197to forward incoming connections.
1198
1199A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1200parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001202All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1203'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1204case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1205
1206Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1207logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1208proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1209However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1210name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1211
1212Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1213and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001214bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1216modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1217arbitrary criteria.
1218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001219In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1220a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1221the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1222
1223 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1224 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1225 between responses and new requests.
1226
1227 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1228 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1229 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1230 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1231
1232 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1233 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1234 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1235
1236 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1237 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1238 client-facing connection remains open.
1239
1240 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1241 after the end of the response.
1242
1243The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1244frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1245following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1246weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1247
1248 Backend mode
1249
1250 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1251 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1252 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1253 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1254 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1255 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1256 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1257 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1258 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1265--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001267The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1268limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1269they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1270limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001272option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001273and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1274with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1275specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001277
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1279------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1280acl - X X X
1281appsession - - X X
1282backlog X X X -
1283balance X - X X
1284bind - X X -
1285bind-process X X X X
1286block - X X X
1287capture cookie - X X -
1288capture request header - X X -
1289capture response header - X X -
1290clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001291compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001292contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1293cookie X - X X
1294default-server X - X X
1295default_backend X X X -
1296description - X X X
1297disabled X X X X
1298dispatch - - X X
1299enabled X X X X
1300errorfile X X X X
1301errorloc X X X X
1302errorloc302 X X X X
1303-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1304errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001305force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306fullconn X - X X
1307grace X X X X
1308hash-type X - X X
1309http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001310http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001311http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001312http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001313http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001314http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001316ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001317log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001318max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319maxconn X X X -
1320mode X X X X
1321monitor fail - X X -
1322monitor-net X X X -
1323monitor-uri X X X -
1324option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1325option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1326option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1327option allbackups (*) X - X X
1328option checkcache (*) X - X X
1329option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1330option contstats (*) X X X -
1331option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1332option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1333option forceclose (*) X X X X
1334-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1335option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001336option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001337option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001338option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001339option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001340option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001341option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1342option httpchk X - X X
1343option httpclose (*) X X X X
1344option httplog X X X X
1345option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001346option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001347option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001348option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1350option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1351option logasap (*) X X X -
1352option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001353option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001354option nolinger (*) X X X X
1355option originalto X X X X
1356option persist (*) X - X X
1357option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001358option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001359option smtpchk X - X X
1360option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1361option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1362option splice-request (*) X X X X
1363option splice-response (*) X X X X
1364option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1365option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1366-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001367option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1369option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1370option tcpka X X X X
1371option tcplog X X X X
1372option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001373external-check command X - X X
1374external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1376rate-limit sessions X X X -
1377redirect - X X X
1378redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1379redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1380reqadd - X X X
1381reqallow - X X X
1382reqdel - X X X
1383reqdeny - X X X
1384reqiallow - X X X
1385reqidel - X X X
1386reqideny - X X X
1387reqipass - X X X
1388reqirep - X X X
1389reqisetbe - X X X
1390reqitarpit - X X X
1391reqpass - X X X
1392reqrep - X X X
1393-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1394reqsetbe - X X X
1395reqtarpit - X X X
1396retries X - X X
1397rspadd - X X X
1398rspdel - X X X
1399rspdeny - X X X
1400rspidel - X X X
1401rspideny - X X X
1402rspirep - X X X
1403rsprep - X X X
1404server - - X X
1405source X - X X
1406srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001407stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001408stats auth X - X X
1409stats enable X - X X
1410stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001411stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412stats realm X - X X
1413stats refresh X - X X
1414stats scope X - X X
1415stats show-desc X - X X
1416stats show-legends X - X X
1417stats show-node X - X X
1418stats uri X - X X
1419-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1420stick match - - X X
1421stick on - - X X
1422stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001423stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001424stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001425tcp-check connect - - X X
1426tcp-check expect - - X X
1427tcp-check send - - X X
1428tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001429tcp-request connection - X X -
1430tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001431tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001432tcp-response content - - X X
1433tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434timeout check X - X X
1435timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001436timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001437timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1438timeout connect X - X X
1439timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1440timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1441timeout http-request X X X X
1442timeout queue X - X X
1443timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001444timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001445timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001447timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001448transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001449unique-id-format X X X -
1450unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001452use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1454 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1458---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
1460This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1461
1462
1463acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1464 Declare or complete an access list.
1465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1466 no | yes | yes | yes
1467 Example:
1468 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1469 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1470 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
1474
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1476 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1479 no | no | yes | yes
1480 Arguments :
1481 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1482 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1483
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001484 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485 checked in each cookie value.
1486
1487 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1488 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1489 milliseconds.
1490
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001491 request-learn
1492 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1493 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1494 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1495 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1496 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1497 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1498
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1500 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1501 data following this prefix.
1502
1503 Example :
1504 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1505
1506 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1507 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1508
1509 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1510 2 modes are currently supported :
1511 - path-parameters :
1512 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1513 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1514 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1515 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1516 - query-string :
1517 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1518 query string.
1519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1521 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1522 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1523 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001524 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1525 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1526 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1528 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1529
1530 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001532 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1533 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1534 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536 Example :
1537 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1538
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001539 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1540 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
1542
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001543backlog <conns>
1544 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1546 yes | yes | yes | no
1547 Arguments :
1548 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1549 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001550 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001551
1552 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1553 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1554 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1555 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1556 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1557 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1558 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1559 backlog parameter.
1560
1561 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1562 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1563 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1564
1565 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1566
1567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001569balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1572 yes | no | yes | yes
1573 Arguments :
1574 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1575 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1576 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1577 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1578
1579 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1580 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1581 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1582 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001583 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001584 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001585 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1586 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1587 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1588 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1589 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1590 it, so that you don't worry.
1591
1592 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1593 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1594 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1595 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1596 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1597 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1598 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1599 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001601 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1602 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1603 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1604 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1605 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1606 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1607 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1608 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1609
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001610 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001611 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001612 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1613 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001614 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001615 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1616 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1617 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1618 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1619 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1621 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1622 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1623 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1624 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1625 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1628 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1629 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1630 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1631 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1632 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1633 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1634 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001635 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001637 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1638 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1639 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001640
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001641 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1642 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1643 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1644 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1645 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1646 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1647 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1648 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1649 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1652 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001653
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001654 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001655 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1656 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1657 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1658 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1659 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1660 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1661 URIs start with a leading "/".
1662
1663 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1664 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1665 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1666 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001669 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1670
1671 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001672 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1673 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001674 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1675 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1676 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1677 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001679 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1680 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001681
1682 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1683 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1684 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1685 server will receive the request.
1686
1687 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1688 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1689 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1690 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1691 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001692 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1693 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1694 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001696 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1697 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1698 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1699 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1700 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001702 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001703 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1704 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1705 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1706
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001707 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1708 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1709 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1710
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001711 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001712 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001713 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1714 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1715 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1716 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1717 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1718 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001719 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001720 used instead.
1721
1722 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1723 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1724 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1725 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1726
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001727 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1728 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1729 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1730
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001731 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001734 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1735 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001736
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001737 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1738 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1739 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740
1741 Examples :
1742 balance roundrobin
1743 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001744 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001745 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1746 balance hdr(host)
1747 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001748
1749 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1750 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001752 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001753 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1754 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1755 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1756 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1757
1758 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1759 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1760 defaults to 16 kB.
1761
1762 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1763 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1764
1765 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1766 Round Robin.
1767
1768 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1769 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1770 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1771 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1772
1773 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1774
1775 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001776 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001777 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1778 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1779 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001781 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1782 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783
1784
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001785bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1786bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1789 no | yes | yes | no
1790 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001791 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1792 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1793 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1794 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001795 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001796 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1797 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1798 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1799 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1800 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1801 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1802 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001803 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1804 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1805 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1806 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1807 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1808 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1809 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001810 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1811 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1812 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001813 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1814 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1815 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1816 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001817
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001818 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1819 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1821 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1822 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001823 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1824 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1825 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1826 the range.
1827
1828 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1829 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1830 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1831 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1832 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1833 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1834 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001835 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001836 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001838 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1839 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1840 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1841 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1842 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1843 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1844 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1845 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1846
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001847 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1848 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1849 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1850 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001852 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1853 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1854 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1855 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1856 in a frontend.
1857
1858 Example :
1859 listen http_proxy
1860 bind :80,:443
1861 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001862 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001864 listen http_https_proxy
1865 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001866 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001867
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001868 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1869 bind ipv6@:80
1870 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1871 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1872
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001873 listen external_bind_app1
1874 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1875
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001877 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
1879
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001880bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001881 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1883 yes | yes | yes | yes
1884 Arguments :
1885 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1886 may be used to override a default value.
1887
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001888 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001889 option may be combined with other numbers.
1890
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001891 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001892 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1893 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1894 missing from all processes.
1895
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001896 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001898 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1899 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1900 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1901 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001902
1903 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1904 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1905 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1906 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1907 and 'even' instances.
1908
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001909 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1910 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1911 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1912 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001913
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001914 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1915 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1916
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001917 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1918 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1919 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1920
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001921 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1922 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1923
1924 Example :
1925 listen app_ip1
1926 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001927 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001928
1929 listen app_ip2
1930 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001931 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001932
1933 listen management
1934 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001935 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001936
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001937 listen management
1938 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1939 bind-process 1-4
1940
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001941 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
1943
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001944block { if | unless } <condition>
1945 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1947 no | yes | yes | yes
1948
1949 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1950 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001951 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001952 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1954 "block" statements per instance.
1955
1956 Example:
1957 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1958 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1959 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1960 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001962 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001963
1964
1965capture cookie <name> len <length>
1966 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1968 no | yes | yes | no
1969 Arguments :
1970 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1971 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1972 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1973 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1974 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1975
1976 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1977 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1978 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1979 right if it exceeds <length>.
1980
1981 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1982 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1983 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1984 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1985
1986 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1987 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1988 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1989
1990 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1991 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1992 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001993 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1994 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1995 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001996
1997 Example:
1998 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1999
2000 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002001 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
2003
2004capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002005 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2007 no | yes | yes | no
2008 Arguments :
2009 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002010 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2012 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2013 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2014
2015 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2016 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2017 it exceeds <length>.
2018
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002019 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2021 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002022 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2023 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2024 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2025 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002026 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002027 environments to find where the request came from.
2028
2029 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2030 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2031 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2032 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002033
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002034 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2035 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2036 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2037 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2038 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
2040 Example:
2041 capture request header Host len 15
2042 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2043 capture request header Referrer len 15
2044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002045 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 about logging.
2047
2048
2049capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002050 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2052 no | yes | yes | no
2053 Arguments :
2054 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002055 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2057 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2058 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2059
2060 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2061 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2062 it exceeds <length>.
2063
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002064 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2066 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2067 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002068 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2069 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2070 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2071 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002073 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2074 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2075 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2076 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2077 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078
2079 Example:
2080 capture response header Content-length len 9
2081 capture response header Location len 15
2082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002083 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084 about logging.
2085
2086
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002087clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002088 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2090 yes | yes | yes | no
2091 Arguments :
2092 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2094 as explained at the top of this document.
2095
2096 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2097 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2098 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2099 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2100 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2101 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2102 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2103 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002104 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2106 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2107
2108 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2109 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2110 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2111 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2112 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2113 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2114
2115 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2116 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2117
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002118 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2119 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002120
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002121compression algo <algorithm> ...
2122compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002123compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002124 Enable HTTP compression.
2125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2126 yes | yes | yes | yes
2127 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002128 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2129 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2130 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2131
2132 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002133 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002134 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2135 data.
2136
2137 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2138 support for zlib was built in.
2139
2140 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2141 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2142 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2143 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2144 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2145 in.
2146
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002147 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002148 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002149 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2150 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2151 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2152 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2153 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002154
2155 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2156 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2157 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2158 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2159 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002160 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2161 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2162 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2163 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2164 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002165 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2166 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002167
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002168 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002169 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2170 "Accept-Encoding" header
2171 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002172 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002173 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2174 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002175 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2176 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2177 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2178 "multipart"
2179 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2180 header
2181 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2182 and later
2183 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2184 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002185
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002186 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2187 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002188
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002189 Examples :
2190 compression algo gzip
2191 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002193contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2196 yes | no | yes | yes
2197 Arguments :
2198 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2199 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2200 as explained at the top of this document.
2201
2202 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002203 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002204 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2206 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2207 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2208 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2209
2210 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2211 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2212 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2213 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2214 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2215 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2216
2217 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2218 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2219 instead.
2220
2221 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2222 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2223
2224
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002225cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002226 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2227 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2230 yes | no | yes | yes
2231 Arguments :
2232 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2233 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2234 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2235 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2236 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2237 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2238 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2239 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2240 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2241
2242 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2243 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2244 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2245 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2246 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2247 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2248 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2249 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2250 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2251 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2252 "insert" and "prefix".
2253
2254 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002255 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002256
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002257 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002258 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2259 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2260 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2261 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2262 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2263 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2264 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2265 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2266 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2267 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268
2269 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2270 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2271 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2272 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2273 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2274 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2275 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2276 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2277 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2278 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002279 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2280 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2281 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002283 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2284 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2285 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002286 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2287 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2288 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2289 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002290 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2291 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2292 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002293
2294 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2295 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2296 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2297 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2298 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2299 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2300 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2301 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2302 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2303
2304 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2305 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2306 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2307 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2308 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2309 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2310 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2311 persistence cookie in the cache.
2312 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2313
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002314 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2315 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2316 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2317 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2318 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2319 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2320 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2321 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2322 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2323 they logout.
2324
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002325 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2326 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2327 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2328 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2329
2330 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2331 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2332 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2333 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2334 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2335 this attribute.
2336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002337 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002338 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002339 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2340 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2341 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2342 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2343 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2344 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002345
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002346 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2347 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2348 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2349 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2350 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2351 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2352 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2353 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2354 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2355 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2356 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2357 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2358 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2359 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2360 the site.
2361
2362 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2363 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2364 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2365 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2366 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2367 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2368 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2369 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2370 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2371 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2372 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2373 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2374 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2375 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2376 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2377 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2380 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2381 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2382 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384 Examples :
2385 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2386 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2387 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002388 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002390 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002391 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002394default-server [param*]
2395 Change default options for a server in a backend
2396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 yes | no | yes | yes
2398 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002399 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2400 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2401 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2402 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002403
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002404 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002405 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2406
2407 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002408
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002410default_backend <backend>
2411 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2413 yes | yes | yes | no
2414 Arguments :
2415 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2416
2417 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2418 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2419 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2420 will catch all undetermined requests.
2421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422 Example :
2423
2424 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2425 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2426 default_backend dynamic
2427
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002428 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002431description <string>
2432 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2434 no | yes | yes | yes
2435 Arguments : string
2436
2437 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2438 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2439 it describes.
2440 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2441
2442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443disabled
2444 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2446 yes | yes | yes | yes
2447 Arguments : none
2448
2449 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2450 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2451 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2452 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2453 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2454 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2455 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2456
2457 See also : "enabled"
2458
2459
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002460dispatch <address>:<port>
2461 Set a default server address
2462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002464 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002465
2466 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2467 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2468 during start-up.
2469
2470 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2471 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2472 possible with normal servers.
2473
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002474 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002475 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2476 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2477 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2478 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2479
2480 See also : "server"
2481
2482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483enabled
2484 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2486 yes | yes | yes | yes
2487 Arguments : none
2488
2489 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2490 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2491
2492 See also : "disabled"
2493
2494
2495errorfile <code> <file>
2496 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2498 yes | yes | yes | yes
2499 Arguments :
2500 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002501 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002502
2503 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002504 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002506 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2507 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
2509 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2510 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2511 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2512
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002513 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2516 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2517 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2518 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2519
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002520 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2521 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2522 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2523 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2524 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2525 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2528 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2529 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002530 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002531 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2532
2533 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2534
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002535 Example :
2536 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002537 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002538 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2539 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2540
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002541
2542errorloc <code> <url>
2543errorloc302 <code> <url>
2544 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2546 yes | yes | yes | yes
2547 Arguments :
2548 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002549 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002550
2551 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2552 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2553 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2554 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2555 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2556
2557 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2558 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2559 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2560
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002561 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2562
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002563 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2564 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2565 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2566 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2567 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2568 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2569 request.
2570
2571 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2572
2573
2574errorloc303 <code> <url>
2575 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2577 yes | yes | yes | yes
2578 Arguments :
2579 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2580 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2581
2582 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2583 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2584 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2585 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2586 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2587
2588 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2589 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2590 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2591
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002592 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2593
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002594 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2595 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2596 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2597 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002598 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002599
2600 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2601
2602
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002603force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2604 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2606 no | yes | yes | yes
2607
2608 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2609 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2610 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2611 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2612 marked down for maintenance operations.
2613
2614 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2615 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2616 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2617 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2618 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2619 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2620 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2621 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2622 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2623
2624 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2625 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2626 is used.
2627
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002628 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002629 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002630
2631
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002632fullconn <conns>
2633 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2635 yes | no | yes | yes
2636 Arguments :
2637 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2638 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2639
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002640 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002641 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002642 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002643 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2644 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2645 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2646 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2647 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002648 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002650 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2651 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002652 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2653 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2654 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002655
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002656 Example :
2657 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2658 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2659 # connections.
2660 backend dynamic
2661 fullconn 10000
2662 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2663 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2664
2665 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2666
2667
2668grace <time>
2669 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002671 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002672 Arguments :
2673 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2674 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2675 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2676
2677 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2678 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002679 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002680 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2681
2682 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2683 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2684 simplify it.
2685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002687hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002688 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2690 yes | no | yes | yes
2691 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002692 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2693 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002694
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002695 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2696 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2697 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2698 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2699 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2700 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2701 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2702 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2703 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2704 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002705
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002706 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2707 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2708 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2709 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2710 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2711 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2712 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2713 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2714 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2715 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2716 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2717 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2718 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002719 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2720 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002721
2722 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2723
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002724 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002725 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2726 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2727 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002728 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2729 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2730 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002731
2732 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2733 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002734 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2735 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2736 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2737 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2738
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002739 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2740 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2741 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2742 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2743 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2744 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2745 parameter.
2746
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002747 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2748
2749 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2750 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2751 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2752 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2753 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2754 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2755 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2756 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2757 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2758 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2759 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2760 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002761
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002762 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2763 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2764 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002765
2766 See also : "balance", "server"
2767
2768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769http-check disable-on-404
2770 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002772 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002773 Arguments : none
2774
2775 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2776 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2777 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2778 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2779 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2780 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2781 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2782 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002783 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2784 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2785 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2786
2787 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2788
2789
2790http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002791 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002793 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002794 Arguments :
2795 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2796 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002797 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2799 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2800 details on the supported keywords.
2801
2802 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2803 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2804 with the usual backslash ('\').
2805
2806 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2807 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2808 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2809 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2810 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2811
2812 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002813 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002814 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2815 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2816 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2817
2818 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002820 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2821 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2822 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2823 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2824
2825 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002826 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002827 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2828 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2829 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2830 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2831 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2832 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2833 trace).
2834
2835 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002836 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002837 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2838 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2839 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2840 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2841 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2842 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2843
2844 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2845 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2846 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2847 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2848 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2849 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2850 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2851 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2852
2853 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2854 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2855
2856 Examples :
2857 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002858 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002859
2860 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002861 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002862
2863 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002864 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002865
2866 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002867 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002869 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002870
2871
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002872http-check send-state
2873 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2875 yes | no | yes | yes
2876 Arguments : none
2877
2878 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2879 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2880 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2881 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2882 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2883
2884 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2885 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2886 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2887 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2888 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2889 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2890 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2891 checked in multiple backends.
2892
2893 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2894 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2895
2896 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2897 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2898 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2899 one fails.
2900
2901 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2902 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2903 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2904
2905 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2906 server's queue.
2907
2908 Example of a header received by the application server :
2909 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2910 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2911
2912 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2913
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002914http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002915 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002916 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002917 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2918 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002919 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2920 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2921 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2922 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02002923 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
2924 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002925 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002926 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002927 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2928
2929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2930 no | yes | yes | yes
2931
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002932 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2933 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2934 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2935 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2936 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002937
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002938 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2939 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2940 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2941
2942 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2943 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2944 are evaluated.
2945
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002946 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2947 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2948 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2949 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2950 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2951 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2952 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2953 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2954 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002955 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002956 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2957
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002958 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2959 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2960 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2961 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2962 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2963
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002964 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2965 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2966 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002967 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2968 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002969
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002970 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2971 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2972 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2973 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2974 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2975 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2976 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2977 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2978
2979 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2980 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2981 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2982 external users.
2983
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002984 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2985 <name>.
2986
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002987 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2988 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2989 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2990 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2991 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2992 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2993 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2994 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2995
2996 Example:
2997
2998 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2999
3000 applied to:
3001
3002 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3003
3004 outputs:
3005
3006 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3007
3008 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3009
3010 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3011 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3012 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3013 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3014 header.
3015
3016 Example:
3017
3018 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3019
3020 applied to:
3021
3022 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3023
3024 outputs:
3025
3026 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3027
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003028 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3029 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3030 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3031 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3032 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3033 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3034 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3035 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3036
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003037 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3038 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3039 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3040 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3041 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3042 another equipment.
3043
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003044 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3045 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3046 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3047 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3048 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3049 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3050 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3051 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3052
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003053 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3054 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3055 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3056 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3057 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3058 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3059 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3060 admin privileges.
3061
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003062 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3063 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3064 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3065 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3066 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3067 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3068 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3069 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3070
3071 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3072 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3073 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3074 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3075 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3076 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3077
3078 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3079 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3080 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3081 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3082 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3083 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3084
3085 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3086 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3087 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3088 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3089 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3090 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3091 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3092 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3093 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3094
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003095 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3096 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3097 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3098 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3099 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3100 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3101 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3102 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3103 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3104 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3105 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3106 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3107
3108 These actions take one or two arguments :
3109 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3110 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3111 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3112 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3113
3114 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3115 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3116 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3117 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3118
3119 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3120 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3121 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3122 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3123 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3124 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3125 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3126 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3127
3128 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3129 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3130 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3131 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3132 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3133
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003134 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3135
3136 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3137 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3138 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3139 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003140
3141 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003142 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3143 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3144 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003145
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003146 http-request allow if nagios
3147 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3148 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3149 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003150
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003151 Example:
3152 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003153 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003154
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003155 Example:
3156 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3157 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3158 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3159 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3160 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3161 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3162 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3163 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3164 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3165
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003166 Example:
3167 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3168 acl add path /addacl
3169 acl del path /delacl
3170
3171 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3172
3173 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3174 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3175
3176 Example:
3177 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3178 acl setmap path /setmap
3179 acl delmap path /delmap
3180
3181 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3182
3183 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3184 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3185
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003186 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3187 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003188
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003189http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003190 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003191 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3192 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003193 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3194 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3195 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3196 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3197 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3198 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003199 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003200 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3201
3202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3203 no | yes | yes | yes
3204
3205 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3206 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3207 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3208 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3209 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3210 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3211
3212 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3213 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3214 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3215 current section.
3216
3217 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3218 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3219 rules are evaluated.
3220
3221 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3222 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3223 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3224 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3225 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3226 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3227 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3228
3229 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3230 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3231 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3232 external users.
3233
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003234 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3235 <name>.
3236
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003237 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3238 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3239 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3240 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3241 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3242 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3243 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3244 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3245
3246 Example:
3247
3248 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3249
3250 applied to:
3251
3252 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3253
3254 outputs:
3255
3256 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3257
3258 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3259
3260 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3261 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3262 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3263 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3264 header.
3265
3266 Example:
3267
3268 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3269
3270 applied to:
3271
3272 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3273
3274 outputs:
3275
3276 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3277
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003278 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3279 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3280 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3281 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3282 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3283 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3284 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3285 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3286
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003287 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3288 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3289 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3290 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3291 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3292 another equipment.
3293
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003294 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3295 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3296 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3297 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3298 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3299 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3300 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3301 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3302
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003303 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3304 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3305 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3306 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3307 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3308 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3309 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3310 admin privileges.
3311
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003312 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3313 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3314 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3315 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3316 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3317 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3318 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3319 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3320
3321 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3322 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3323 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3324 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3325 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3326 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3327
3328 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3329 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3330 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3331 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3332 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3333 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3334
3335 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3336 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3337 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3338 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3339 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3340 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3341 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3342 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3343 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3344
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003345 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3346
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003347 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003348 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3349 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3350 rules.
3351
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003352 Example:
3353 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3354
3355 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3356
3357 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3358 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3359
3360 Example:
3361 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3362
3363 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3364
3365 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3366 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3367
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003368 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3369 ACL usage.
3370
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003371
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003372http-send-name-header [<header>]
3373 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3374
3375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 yes | no | yes | yes
3377
3378 Arguments :
3379
3380 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3381
3382 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3383 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3384 is added with the header string proved.
3385
3386 See also : "server"
3387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003388id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003389 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 no | yes | yes | yes
3392 Arguments : none
3393
3394 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3395 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3396 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003397
3398
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003399ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3400 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 no | yes | yes | yes
3403
3404 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3405 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3406 and running).
3407
3408 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3409 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3410 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003411 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003412 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3413
3414 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3415 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3416
3417 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3418 "unless" condition is met.
3419
3420 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3421
3422
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003423log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003424log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003425no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003426 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003429
3430 Prefix :
3431 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3432 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3433 prefix does not allow arguments.
3434
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003435 Arguments :
3436 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3437 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3438 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3439 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3440 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3441 parameter.
3442
3443 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3444 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3445
3446 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3447 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3448 standard syslog port).
3449
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003450 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3451 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3452 standard syslog port).
3453
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003454 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3455 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3456 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3457 appropriately writeable).
3458
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003459 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3460 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3461 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3462 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3463
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003464 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3465 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3466 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3467 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3468 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3469 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3470 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3471 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3472 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3473 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3474 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3475
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003476 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3477
3478 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3479 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3480 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3481
3482 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3483 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3484 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003485 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3486 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3487 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3488 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3489 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490
3491 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3492
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003493 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3494 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3495 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003496
3497 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3498 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3499 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3500 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3501
3502 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3503 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003504
3505 Example :
3506 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003507 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3508 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003509 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003511
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003512log-format <string>
3513 Allows you to custom a log line.
3514
3515 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3516
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003517
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003518max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3519 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | no | yes | yes
3522
3523 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3524 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3525 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3526 servers.
3527
3528 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3529 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3530 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3531 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3532 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3533 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3534 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3535 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3536 picking a different server.
3537
3538 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3539 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3540 even if they have to be queued.
3541
3542 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3543 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3544
3545
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003546maxconn <conns>
3547 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | yes | yes | no
3550 Arguments :
3551 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3552 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3553 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3554 closes.
3555
3556 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3557 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3558 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3559 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3560 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3561 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3562 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3563 properly tuned.
3564
3565 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3566 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3567 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3568
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003569 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3570
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003571 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3572
3573
3574mode { tcp|http|health }
3575 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3577 yes | yes | yes | yes
3578 Arguments :
3579 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3580 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3581 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3582 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3583
3584 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3585 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3586 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3587 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3588 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3589
3590 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003591 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3592 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3593 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3594 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3595 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3596 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3597 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003599 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3600 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3601 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003602
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003603 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003604 defaults http_instances
3605 mode http
3606
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003607 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003610monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3613 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003614 Arguments :
3615 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3616 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003617 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003618 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3619 backend and its backup.
3620
3621 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3622 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3623 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3624 servers in a list of backends.
3625
3626 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3627 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3628 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3629 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3630 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3631 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3632 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003633 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3634 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635
3636 Example:
3637 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003638 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3640 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3641 monitor-uri /site_alive
3642 monitor fail if site_dead
3643
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003644 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003645
3646
3647monitor-net <source>
3648 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3650 yes | yes | yes | no
3651 Arguments :
3652 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3653 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3654 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3655 followed by a mask.
3656
3657 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3658 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003659 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003660 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3661
3662 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3663 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3664 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3665 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003666 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3667 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3668 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003669
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003670 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3671 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3672 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3673 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3674 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3675 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003676
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003677 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3678 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003679
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003680 Example :
3681 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3682 frontend www
3683 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3684
3685 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3686
3687
3688monitor-uri <uri>
3689 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 yes | yes | yes | no
3692 Arguments :
3693 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3694 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3695
3696 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3697 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3698 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3699 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3700 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3701 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3702 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3703 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3704
3705 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3706 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3707 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3708 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3709 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3710 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3711
3712 Example :
3713 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3714 frontend www
3715 mode http
3716 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3717
3718 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003720
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003721option abortonclose
3722no option abortonclose
3723 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | no | yes | yes
3726 Arguments : none
3727
3728 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3729 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3730 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3731 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003732 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003733 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3734 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3735 encountered while delivering the response.
3736
3737 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3738 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3739 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3740 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3741 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3742 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003743 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003744 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003745 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003746 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3747 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3748 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3749
3750 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3751 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3752 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3753 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3754 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3755 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3756 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3757 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003758 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003759
3760 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3761 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3762
3763 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3764
3765
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003766option accept-invalid-http-request
3767no option accept-invalid-http-request
3768 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | no
3771 Arguments : none
3772
3773 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3774 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3775 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3776 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3777 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3778 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3779 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3780 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003781 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3782 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3783 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3784 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3785 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3786 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003787
3788 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3789 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3790 been confirmed.
3791
3792 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3793 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003794 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3795 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003796 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3797
3798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3800
3801 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3802 stats socket.
3803
3804
3805option accept-invalid-http-response
3806no option accept-invalid-http-response
3807 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3809 yes | no | yes | yes
3810 Arguments : none
3811
3812 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3813 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3814 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3815 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3816 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3817 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3818 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3819 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3820 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3821
3822 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3823 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3824 been confirmed.
3825
3826 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3827 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3828 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3829 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3830
3831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3833
3834 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3835 stats socket.
3836
3837
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003838option allbackups
3839no option allbackups
3840 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3842 yes | no | yes | yes
3843 Arguments : none
3844
3845 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3846 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3847 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3848 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3849 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3850 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3851 order between the backup servers anymore.
3852
3853 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3854 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3855
3856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3858
3859
3860option checkcache
3861no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003862 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 yes | no | yes | yes
3865 Arguments : none
3866
3867 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3868 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003869 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003870 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3871 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003872 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003873
3874 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003875 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003876 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003877 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3878 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003879 to the client are :
3880 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003881 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003882 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003883 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3884 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3885 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3886 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3887 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3888 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3889 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3890 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3891 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3892 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3893 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3894
3895 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003896 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003897 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003898 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003899 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3900
3901 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3902 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003903 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003904 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3905
3906 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3907 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3908
3909
3910option clitcpka
3911no option clitcpka
3912 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3914 yes | yes | yes | no
3915 Arguments : none
3916
3917 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3918 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3919 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3920 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3921
3922 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3923 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3924 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3925 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3926
3927 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3928 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3929 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3930 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3931 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3932
3933 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3934
3935 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3936 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3937 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3938
3939 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3940 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3941
3942 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3943
3944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003945option contstats
3946 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3948 yes | yes | yes | no
3949 Arguments : none
3950
3951 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3952 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3953 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3954 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3955 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3956 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3957 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3958
3959
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003960option dontlog-normal
3961no option dontlog-normal
3962 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3964 yes | yes | yes | no
3965 Arguments : none
3966
3967 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3968 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3969 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3970 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3971 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3972 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3973 logged.
3974
3975 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3976 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3977 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003979 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003980 logging.
3981
3982
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003983option dontlognull
3984no option dontlognull
3985 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | yes | yes | no
3988 Arguments : none
3989
3990 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3991 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3992 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3993 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3994 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3995 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3996 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3997
3998 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3999 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4000 would not be logged.
4001
4002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004005 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004006
4007
4008option forceclose
4009no option forceclose
4010 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004012 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004013 Arguments : none
4014
4015 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4016 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4017 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4018 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4019 global session times in the logs.
4020
4021 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004022 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004023 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004024
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004025 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4026 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4027 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4028
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004029 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4030 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004031
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4034
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004035 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004036
4037
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004038option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004039 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 yes | yes | yes | yes
4042 Arguments :
4043 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4044 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004045 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004046 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004047
4048 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4049 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4050 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4051 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4052 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4053 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4054 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004055 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4056 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4057 possible that the client has already brought one.
4058
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004059 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004060 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004061 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4062 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004063 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4064 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004065
4066 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4067 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4068 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4069 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4070 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4071 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4072 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4073
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004074 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4075 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4076 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4077 are under the control of the end-user.
4078
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004079 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004080 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4081 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004082 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4083 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4084 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004085
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004086 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004087 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4088 frontend www
4089 mode http
4090 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4091
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004092 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4093 backend www
4094 mode http
4095 option forwardfor header X-Client
4096
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004097 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004098 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004099
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004100
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004101option http-keep-alive
4102no option http-keep-alive
4103 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | yes | yes | yes
4106 Arguments : none
4107
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004108 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4109 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4110 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4111 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4112 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4113 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4114 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4115
4116 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4117 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004118 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4119 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4120 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4121 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4122 situations where this option may be useful :
4123
4124 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4125 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4126
4127 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4128 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4129
4130 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4131 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4132 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4133 request.
4134
4135 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4136 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004137 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4138 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4139 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004140
4141 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4142 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4143
4144 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4145 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4146 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4147 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4148 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4149 not set.
4150
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004151 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4152 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004153 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004154 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004155
4156 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004157 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4158 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004159
4160
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004161option http-no-delay
4162no option http-no-delay
4163 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4165 yes | yes | yes | yes
4166 Arguments : none
4167
4168 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4169 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4170 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4171 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4172 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4173 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4174 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4175 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4176 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4177 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4178 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4179 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4180 affected.
4181
4182 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4183 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4184 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4185 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4186 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4187 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4188 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4189 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4190 latency environments.
4191
4192
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004193option http-pretend-keepalive
4194no option http-pretend-keepalive
4195 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4197 yes | yes | yes | yes
4198 Arguments : none
4199
4200 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4201 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4202 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4203 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4204 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4205 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4206 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4207 consider the response complete.
4208
4209 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4210 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4211 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4212 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4213 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4214 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4215
4216 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4217 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4218 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4219 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4220 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4221 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4222 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4223
4224 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4225 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004226 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004227 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4228 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004229
4230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4232
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004233 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4234 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004235
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004236
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004237option http-server-close
4238no option http-server-close
4239 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | yes | yes | yes
4242 Arguments : none
4243
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004244 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4245 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4246 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4247 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4248 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4249 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4250 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4251 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4252 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4253 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4254 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4255 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4256 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4257 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4258 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4259 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004260
4261 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4262 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4263 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4264 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004265 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4266 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004267
4268 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4269 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004270 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4271 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004272 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4273 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004274
4275 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4276 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4277
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004278 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004279 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4280 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004281
4282
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004283option http-tunnel
4284no option http-tunnel
4285 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4287 yes | yes | yes | yes
4288 Arguments : none
4289
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004290 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4291 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4292 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4293 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4294 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4295 "option http-tunnel".
4296
4297 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004298 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004299 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4300 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4301 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4302 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4303 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4304 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4305 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004306
4307 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4308 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4309
4310 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4311 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4312 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4313
4314
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004315option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004316no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004317 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | no
4320 Arguments : none
4321
4322 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4323 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4324 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4325 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4326 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4327 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4328 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4329
4330 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4331 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4332 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4333 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4334 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4335 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4336 request along its whole life.
4337
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004338 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4339 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4340 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4341 front of an existing proxy.
4342
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004343 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4344
4345 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4346 http-server-close".
4347
4348
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004349option httpchk
4350option httpchk <uri>
4351option httpchk <method> <uri>
4352option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4353 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 yes | no | yes | yes
4356 Arguments :
4357 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4358 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4359 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4360 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4361 ones.
4362
4363 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4364 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4365 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4366
4367 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4368 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4369 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4370 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4371 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4372
4373 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4374 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4375 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4376 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4377 the lack of any response.
4378
4379 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4380
4381 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4382 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4383 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4384
4385 Examples :
4386 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4387 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4388 backend https_relay
4389 mode tcp
4390 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4391 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4392
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004393 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4394 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4395 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004396
4397
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004398option httpclose
4399no option httpclose
4400 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | yes
4403 Arguments : none
4404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004405 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4406 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4407 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4408 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004409 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004410 "option http-tunnel".
4411
4412 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4413 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4414 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4415 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4416 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4417 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4418 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4419 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004420
4421 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004422 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004423 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4424 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4425 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4426 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4427 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004428
4429 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4430 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004431 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4432 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004433 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4434 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004435
4436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4438
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004439 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4440 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004441
4442
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004443option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004444 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004447 Arguments :
4448 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4449 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4450 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4451 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4452 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004453
4454 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4455 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4456 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4457 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4458 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4459 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4460 ports.
4461
4462 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4463
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4466 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4467 by default.
4468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004469 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004470
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004471
4472option http_proxy
4473no option http_proxy
4474 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4476 yes | yes | yes | yes
4477 Arguments : none
4478
4479 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4480 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4481 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4482 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4483 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4484
4485 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4486 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4487 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4488 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004489 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004490 be analyzed.
4491
4492 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4493 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4494
4495 Example :
4496 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4497 backend direct_forward
4498 option httpclose
4499 option http_proxy
4500
4501 See also : "option httpclose"
4502
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004503
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004504option independent-streams
4505no option independent-streams
4506 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | yes | yes | yes
4509 Arguments : none
4510
4511 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4512 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4513 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4514 receive data or not.
4515
4516 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4517 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4518 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4519 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4520 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4521 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4522 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4523 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4524 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4525 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4526 socket buffers.
4527
4528 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4529 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4530 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4531 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4532 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4533
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004534 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004535 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4536 deprecated.
4537
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004538 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004539
4540
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004541option ldap-check
4542 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 yes | no | yes | yes
4545 Arguments : none
4546
4547 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4548 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4549 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4550 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4551
4552 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4553 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4554
4555 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4556 configure it.
4557
4558 Example :
4559 option ldap-check
4560
4561 See also : "option httpchk"
4562
4563
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004564option external-check
4565 Use external processes for server health checks
4566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4567 yes | no | yes | yes
4568
4569 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4570 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4571 command".
4572
4573 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4574
4575 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4576
4577
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004578option log-health-checks
4579no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004580 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 yes | no | yes | yes
4583 Arguments : none
4584
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004585 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4586 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4587 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004588
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004589 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4590 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4591 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4592 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4593 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4594
4595 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4596 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004597
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004598 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4599 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4600 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004601
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004602
4603option log-separate-errors
4604no option log-separate-errors
4605 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4607 yes | yes | yes | no
4608 Arguments : none
4609
4610 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4611 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4612 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4613 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4614 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4615 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4616 provides very important information.
4617
4618 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4619 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4620 error logs.
4621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004622 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004623 logging.
4624
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004625
4626option logasap
4627no option logasap
4628 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 yes | yes | yes | no
4631 Arguments : none
4632
4633 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4634 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4635 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4636 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4637 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4638 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4639 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004640 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004641 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4642 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4643
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004644 Examples :
4645 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4646 mode http
4647 option httplog
4648 option logasap
4649 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4650
4651 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4652 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4653 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4654 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004656 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004657 logging.
4658
4659
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004660option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004661 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4663 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004664 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004665 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4666 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004667 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004668
4669 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4670 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4671 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4672 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4673 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4674 in the MySQL table, like this :
4675
4676 USE mysql;
4677 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4678 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4679
4680 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4681 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4682 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4683 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4684 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4685 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4686 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4687 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4688 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4689
4690 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4691 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004692
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004693 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004694
4695 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4696 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4697 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4698 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4699 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4700 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4701
4702 See also: "option httpchk"
4703
4704
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004705option nolinger
4706no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004707 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004708 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004710 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004711
4712 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4713 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4714 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4715 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4716 connections.
4717
4718 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4719 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4720 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4721 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4722 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4723 this too.
4724
4725 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4726 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4727 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4728
4729 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4730 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4731 for servers.
4732
4733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4735
4736
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004737option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4738 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4740 yes | yes | yes | yes
4741 Arguments :
4742 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4743 matching <network>
4744 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4745 header name.
4746
4747 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4748 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4749 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4750 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4751 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4752 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4753 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4754 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4755 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4756 possible that the client has already brought one.
4757
4758 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4759 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4760 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4761 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4762 header and requires different one.
4763
4764 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4765 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4766 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4767 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4768 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4769 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4770 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4771
4772 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4773 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4774 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4775 both are defined.
4776
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004777 Examples :
4778 # Original Destination address
4779 frontend www
4780 mode http
4781 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4782
4783 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4784 backend www
4785 mode http
4786 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4787
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004788 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4789 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004790
4791
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004792option persist
4793no option persist
4794 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4796 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004797 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004798
4799 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4800 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4801 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4802 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4803 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4804 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4805 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4806 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4807 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4808 redirected to another valid server.
4809
4810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4812
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004813 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004814
4815
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004816option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4817 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4819 yes | no | yes | yes
4820 Arguments :
4821 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4822 PostgreSQL server.
4823
4824 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4825 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4826 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4827 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4828
4829 See also: "option httpchk"
4830
4831
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004832option prefer-last-server
4833no option prefer-last-server
4834 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4835 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4836 yes | no | yes | yes
4837 Arguments : none
4838
4839 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4840 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4841 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4842 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4843 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4844 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4845 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4846 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4847 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004848 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4849 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4850 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4851 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4852 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4853 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4854 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004855
4856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4858
4859 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4860
4861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004862option redispatch
4863no option redispatch
4864 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004867 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004868
4869 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4870 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4871 be able to access the service anymore.
4872
4873 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4874 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4875
4876 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4877 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4878 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004880 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4881 "redisp" keywords.
4882
4883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4885
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004886 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004887
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004888
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004889option redis-check
4890 Use redis health checks for server testing
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 yes | no | yes | yes
4893 Arguments : none
4894
4895 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4896 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4897 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4898 find the "+PONG" response message.
4899
4900 Example :
4901 option redis-check
4902
4903 See also : "option httpchk"
4904
4905
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004906option smtpchk
4907option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4908 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004911 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004912 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4913 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4914 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4915
4916 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4917 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4918 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4919
4920 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4921 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4922 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4923 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4924 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4925 dead server.
4926
4927 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4928 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4929 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4930 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4931
4932 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4933 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4934 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4935 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4936 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4937
4938 Example :
4939 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4940
4941 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004944option socket-stats
4945no option socket-stats
4946
4947 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4949 yes | yes | yes | no
4950
4951 Arguments : none
4952
4953
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004954option splice-auto
4955no option splice-auto
4956 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | yes | yes | yes
4959 Arguments : none
4960
4961 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4962 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4963 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4964 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004965 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004966 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4967 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4968 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4969 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4970
4971 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4972 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4973 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4974 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4975 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4976 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4977 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4978 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4979 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4980 keyword.
4981
4982 Example :
4983 option splice-auto
4984
4985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4987
4988 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4989 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4990
4991
4992option splice-request
4993no option splice-request
4994 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4996 yes | yes | yes | yes
4997 Arguments : none
4998
4999 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005000 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005001 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5002 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5003 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5004 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5005
5006 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5007
5008 Example :
5009 option splice-request
5010
5011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5013
5014 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5015 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5016
5017
5018option splice-response
5019no option splice-response
5020 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | yes | yes | yes
5023 Arguments : none
5024
5025 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005026 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005027 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5028 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5029 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5030 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5031
5032 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5033
5034 Example :
5035 option splice-response
5036
5037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5039
5040 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5041 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5042
5043
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005044option srvtcpka
5045no option srvtcpka
5046 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 yes | no | yes | yes
5049 Arguments : none
5050
5051 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5052 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5053 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5054 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5055
5056 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5057 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5058 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5059 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5060
5061 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5062 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5063 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5064 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5065 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5066
5067 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5068
5069 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5070 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5071 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5072
5073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5075
5076 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5077
5078
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005079option ssl-hello-chk
5080 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 yes | no | yes | yes
5083 Arguments : none
5084
5085 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5086 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5087 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5088 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5089 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5090 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5091 hello message.
5092
5093 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5094 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5095 messages, which is appreciable.
5096
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005097 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5098 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5099 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005100
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005101 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5102
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005103
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005104option tcp-check
5105 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5106 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5107 yes | no | yes | yes
5108
5109 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5110 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5111
5112 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5113 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5114 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5115
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005116 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005117 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5118 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5119 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5120 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5121 only.
5122
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005123 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005124 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5125 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5126 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5127 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005129 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005130 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5131 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005132 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005133 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5134 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5135 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5136 the respective protocols.
5137 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5138 analysed.
5139
5140 Examples :
5141 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5142 option tcp-check
5143 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5144
5145 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5146 option tcp-check
5147 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5148
5149 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5150 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005151 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005152 option tcp-check
5153 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5154 tcp-check expect +PONG
5155 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5156 tcp-check expect string role:master
5157 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5158 tcp-check expect string +OK
5159
5160 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5161 (send many headers before analyzing)
5162 option tcp-check
5163 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5164 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5165 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5166 tcp-check send \r\n
5167 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5168
5169
5170 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5171
5172
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005173option tcp-smart-accept
5174no option tcp-smart-accept
5175 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5177 yes | yes | yes | no
5178 Arguments : none
5179
5180 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5181 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5182 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5183 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5184 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5185 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5186
5187 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5188 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5189 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5190 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5191
5192 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5193 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5194 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5195 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5196
5197 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5198 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5199 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5200
5201 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5202 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5203 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5204
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005205 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5206
5207
5208option tcp-smart-connect
5209no option tcp-smart-connect
5210 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 yes | no | yes | yes
5213 Arguments : none
5214
5215 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5216 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5217 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5218 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5219 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5220
5221 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5222 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5223 complex.
5224
5225 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5226 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5227 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5228
5229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5231
5232 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5233
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005234
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005235option tcpka
5236 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5238 yes | yes | yes | yes
5239 Arguments : none
5240
5241 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5242 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5243 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5244 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5245
5246 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5247 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5248 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5249 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5250
5251 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5252 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5253 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5254 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5255 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5256
5257 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5258
5259 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5260 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5261 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5262 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5263 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5264 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5265 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5266 backends.
5267
5268 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5269
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005270
5271option tcplog
5272 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5274 yes | yes | yes | yes
5275 Arguments : none
5276
5277 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5278 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5279 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5280 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5281 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5282 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5283 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5284 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5285
5286 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005288 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005289
5290
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005291option transparent
5292no option transparent
5293 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005295 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005296 Arguments : none
5297
5298 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5299 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5300 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5301 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5302 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5303 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5304 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5305 appropriate server.
5306
5307 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5308 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5309
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005310 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005311 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005312
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005313
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005314external-check command <command>
5315 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5317 yes | no | yes | yes
5318
5319 Arguments :
5320 <command> is the external command to run
5321
5322 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5323 command may be set using "external-check path".
5324
5325 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5326
5327 proxy_address proxy_port server_address server_port
5328
5329 The proxy_address and proxy_port are derived from the first listener
5330 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. It is an error for no such
5331 listeners to exist. In the case of a UNIX socket listener the
5332 proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the proxy_port will
5333 be the string "NOT_USED".
5334
5335 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5336 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5337 failed.
5338
5339 Example :
5340 external-check command /bin/true
5341
5342 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5343
5344
5345external-check path <path>
5346 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | no | yes | yes
5349
5350 Arguments :
5351 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5352
5353 The default path is "".
5354
5355 Example :
5356 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5357
5358 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5359 "external-check command"
5360
5361
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005362persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005363persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005364 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 yes | no | yes | yes
5367 Arguments :
5368 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005369 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5370 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005371
5372 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5373 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5374 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5375 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5376 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5377 forwarded to this server.
5378
5379 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5380 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5381 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005382 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005383 a single "listen" section.
5384
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005385 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5386 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5387 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5388
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005389 Example :
5390 listen tse-farm
5391 bind :3389
5392 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5393 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5394 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5395 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5396 persist rdp-cookie
5397 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005398 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005399 balance rdp-cookie
5400 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5401 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5402
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005403 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5404 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005405
5406
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005407rate-limit sessions <rate>
5408 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5410 yes | yes | yes | no
5411 Arguments :
5412 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5413 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5414
5415 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5416 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5417 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5418 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5419 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5420 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5421
5422 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5423 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5424 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5425 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5426
5427 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5428 listen smtp
5429 mode tcp
5430 bind :25
5431 rate-limit sessions 10
5432 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5433
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005434 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5435 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5436 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005437
5438 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5439
5440
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005441redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5442redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5443redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005444 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5446 no | yes | yes | yes
5447
5448 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005449 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005450
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005451 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005452 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005453 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5454 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5455 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005456
5457 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5458 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5459 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5460 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5461 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005462 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5463 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5464 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5465 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005466
5467 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5468 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5469 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5470 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5471 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5472 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005473 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005474 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005475 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5476 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5477 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005478
5479 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005480 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5481 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5482 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5483 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5484 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5485 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5486 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5487 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005488
5489 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5490 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5491
5492 - "drop-query"
5493 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5494 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5495 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5496 with a location-type redirect.
5497
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005498 - "append-slash"
5499 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5500 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5501 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5502 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5503
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005504 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5505 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5506 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5507 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5508 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5509 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5510 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5511
5512 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5513 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5514 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5515 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5516 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5517 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5518 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005519
5520 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5521 acl clear dst_port 80
5522 acl secure dst_port 8080
5523 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005524 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005525 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005526 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5527
5528 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005529 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5530 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5531 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005532 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005533
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005534 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5535 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5536 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5537
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005538 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005539 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005540
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005541 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5542 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5543 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005545 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005546
5547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005548redisp (deprecated)
5549redispatch (deprecated)
5550 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005553 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005554
5555 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5556 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5557 be able to access the service anymore.
5558
5559 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5560 redistribute them to a working server.
5561
5562 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5563 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5564 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005566 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5567 "option redispatch" instead.
5568
5569 See also : "option redispatch"
5570
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005571
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005572reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005573 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 no | yes | yes | yes
5576 Arguments :
5577 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5578 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005579 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005580
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005581 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5582 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5583
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005584 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5585 the last header of an HTTP request.
5586
5587 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5588 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5589 responses.
5590
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005591 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5592 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5593 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5594
5595 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5596 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005597
5598
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005599reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5600reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005601 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5603 no | yes | yes | yes
5604 Arguments :
5605 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5606 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5607 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5608 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5609 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5610 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5611 ignores case.
5612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005613 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5614 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5615
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005616 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5617 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5618 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5619 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005620 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005621
5622 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5623 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5624
5625 Example :
5626 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5627 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5628 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5629
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005630 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5631 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005632
5633
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005634reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5635reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005636 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5638 no | yes | yes | yes
5639 Arguments :
5640 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5641 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5642 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5643 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5644 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5645 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5646
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005647 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5648 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5649
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005650 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5651 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5652 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5653 next servers.
5654
5655 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5656 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5657 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5658
5659 Example :
5660 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5661 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5662 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5663
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005664 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5665 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005666
5667
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005668reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5669reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005670 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5672 no | yes | yes | yes
5673 Arguments :
5674 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5675 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5676 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5677 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5678 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5679 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5680 case.
5681
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005682 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5683 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5684
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005685 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5686 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5687 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5688 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005689 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005690
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005691 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005692 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005693 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005694
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005695 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5696 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5697
5698 Example :
5699 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5700 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5701 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5702
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005703 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5704 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005705
5706
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005707reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5708reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5711 no | yes | yes | yes
5712 Arguments :
5713 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5714 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5715 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5716 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5717 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5718 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5719 case.
5720
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005721 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5722 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5723
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005724 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5725 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5726 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5727 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5728
5729 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5730 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5731
5732 Example :
5733 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5734 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5735 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5736 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5737
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005738 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5739 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005740
5741
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005742reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5743reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005744 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5746 no | yes | yes | yes
5747 Arguments :
5748 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5749 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5750 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5751 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5752 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5753 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5754
5755 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5756 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5757 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5758 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005759 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005760
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005761 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5762 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5763
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005764 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5765 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5766 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5767
5768 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5769 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5770 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5771 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5772 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5773
5774 Example :
5775 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005776 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005777 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5778 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5779
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005780 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5781 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005782
5783
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005784reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5785reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005786 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 no | yes | yes | yes
5789 Arguments :
5790 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5791 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5792 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5793 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5794 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5795 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5796 ignores case.
5797
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005798 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5799 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5800
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005801 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5802 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005803 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5804 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5805 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005806 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5807 not set.
5808
5809 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5810 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5811 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5812 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5813 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5814
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005815 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005816 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5817 # block all others.
5818 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5819 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5820
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005821 # block bad guys
5822 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5823 reqitarpit . if badguys
5824
5825 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5826 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005827
5828
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005829retries <value>
5830 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5831 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
5833 Arguments :
5834 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5835 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5836 default value is 3.
5837
5838 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5839 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5840 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5841
5842 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5843 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5844
5845 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5846 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5847
5848 See also : "option redispatch"
5849
5850
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005851rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005852 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5854 no | yes | yes | yes
5855 Arguments :
5856 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5857 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005858 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005859
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005860 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5861 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5862
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005863 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5864 the last header of an HTTP response.
5865
5866 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5867 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5868 responses.
5869
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005870 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5871 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005872
5873
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005874rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5875rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005876 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5878 no | yes | yes | yes
5879 Arguments :
5880 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5881 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5882 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5883 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5884 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5885 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5886 ignores case.
5887
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005888 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5889 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5890
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005891 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5892 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005893 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005894 client.
5895
5896 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5897 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5898 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5899
5900 Example :
5901 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005902 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005903
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005904 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5905 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005906
5907
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005908rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5909rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005910 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5912 no | yes | yes | yes
5913 Arguments :
5914 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5915 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5916 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5917 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5918 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5919 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5920 ignores case.
5921
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005922 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5923 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5924
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005925 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5926 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5927 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5928 case-sensitive.
5929
5930 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005931 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5932 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5933 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005934
5935 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5936 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5937
5938 Example :
5939 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5940 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5941
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005942 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5943 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005944
5945
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005946rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5947rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005948 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 no | yes | yes | yes
5951 Arguments :
5952 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5953 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5954 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5955 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5956 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5957 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5958 ignores case.
5959
5960 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5961 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5962 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5963 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005964 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005965
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005966 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5967 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5968
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005969 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5970 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5971 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5972
5973 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5974 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5975 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5976 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5977 are not case-sensitive.
5978
5979 Example :
5980 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5981 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5982
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005983 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5984 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005985
5986
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005987server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005988 Declare a server in a backend
5989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 no | no | yes | yes
5991 Arguments :
5992 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005993 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005994 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005995
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005996 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5997 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5998 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5999 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006000 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6001 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6002 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6003 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6004 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006005 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6006 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6007 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6008 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6009 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6010 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6011 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006012 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006013 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6014 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6015 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6016 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006017
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006018 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006019 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6020 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6021 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6022 adding this value to the client's port.
6023
6024 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6025 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006026 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006027
6028 Examples :
6029 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6030 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006031 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006032 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6033 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6034 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006035
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006036 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6037 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006038
6039
6040source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006041source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006042source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006043 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | no | yes | yes
6046 Arguments :
6047 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6048 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006049
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006050 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006051 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6052 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6053 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6054 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6055 supported prefixes are :
6056 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6057 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6058 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006059 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006060 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6061 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6062 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6063 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006064
6065 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6066 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006067 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6068 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6069 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006070
6071 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6072 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6073 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6074 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6075 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6076 <addr>.
6077
6078 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6079 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6080 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6081 port.
6082
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006083 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6084 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6085 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6086 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006087 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006088 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6089 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6090 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6091 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6092 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6093 HTTP header.
6094
6095 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6096 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006097 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006098 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6099 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6100 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6101 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6102 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6103 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6104 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6105
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006106 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6107 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6108 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6109 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6110 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6111 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6112
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006113 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6114 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6115 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6116 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6117
6118 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6119 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6120 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6121 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6122 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6123 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6124
6125 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6126 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6127 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6128 there are two methods :
6129
6130 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6131 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6132 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6133 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6134 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6135 of the client ranges may be used.
6136
6137 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6138 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6139 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6140 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6141 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6142 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6143 same session.
6144
6145 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6146 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6147 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6148 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6149 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6150 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6151
6152 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6153 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6154 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006155 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006156
6157 Examples :
6158 backend private
6159 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6160 source 192.168.1.200
6161
6162 backend transparent_ssl1
6163 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6164 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6165
6166 backend transparent_ssl2
6167 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6168 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6169 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6170
6171 backend transparent_ssl3
6172 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6173 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6174 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6175
6176 backend transparent_smtp
6177 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6178 # with Tproxy version 4.
6179 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6180
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006181 backend transparent_http
6182 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6183 # proxy.
6184 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006186 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006187 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006189
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006190srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6191 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | no | yes | yes
6194 Arguments :
6195 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6196 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6197 as explained at the top of this document.
6198
6199 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6200 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6201 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6202 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6203 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6204 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6205 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6206
6207 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6208 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6209 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6210 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6211 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006212 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006213 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006214 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006215
6216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6222
6223 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6224 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6225
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006226 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6227 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006228
6229
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006230stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6231 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006233 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006234
6235 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6236 matched.
6237
6238 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6239 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6240
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006241 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6242 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6243 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6244
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006245 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6246 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6247 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6248 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006249
6250 Example :
6251 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6252 backend stats_localhost
6253 stats enable
6254 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6255
6256 Example :
6257 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6258 backend stats_auth
6259 stats enable
6260 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6261 stats admin if TRUE
6262
6263 Example :
6264 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6265 userlist stats-auth
6266 group admin users admin
6267 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6268 group readonly users haproxy
6269 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6270
6271 backend stats_auth
6272 stats enable
6273 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6274 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6275 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6276 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6277
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006278 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6279 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6280 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006281
6282
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006283stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6284 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006286 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006287 Arguments :
6288 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6289
6290 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6291
6292 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6293 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6294 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6295 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6296 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6297 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6298
6299 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6300 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6301 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006302 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006303
6304 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6305 report using "stats scope".
6306
6307 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6308 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6309 unobvious parameters.
6310
6311 Example :
6312 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6313 backend public_www
6314 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6315 stats enable
6316 stats hide-version
6317 stats scope .
6318 stats uri /admin?stats
6319 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6320 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6321 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6322
6323 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6324 backend private_monitoring
6325 stats enable
6326 stats uri /admin?stats
6327 stats refresh 5s
6328
6329 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6330
6331
6332stats enable
6333 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006335 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006336 Arguments : none
6337
6338 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6339 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6340 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6341 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6342 - stats auth : no authentication
6343 - stats scope : no restriction
6344
6345 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6346 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6347 unobvious parameters.
6348
6349 Example :
6350 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6351 backend public_www
6352 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6353 stats enable
6354 stats hide-version
6355 stats scope .
6356 stats uri /admin?stats
6357 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6358 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6359 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6360
6361 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6362 backend private_monitoring
6363 stats enable
6364 stats uri /admin?stats
6365 stats refresh 5s
6366
6367 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6368
6369
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006370stats hide-version
6371 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006373 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006374 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006375
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006376 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6377 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6378 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6379 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6380 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6381 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006383 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6384 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6385 unobvious parameters.
6386
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006387 Example :
6388 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6389 backend public_www
6390 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006391 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006392 stats hide-version
6393 stats scope .
6394 stats uri /admin?stats
6395 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6396 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6397 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006398
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006399 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6400 backend private_monitoring
6401 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006402 stats uri /admin?stats
6403 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006404
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006405 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006406
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006407
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006408stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6409 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6410 Access control for statistics
6411
6412 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6413 no | no | yes | yes
6414
6415 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6416 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6417 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6418 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6419 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6420 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6421
6422 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6423 instance.
6424
6425 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6426 about ACL usage.
6427
6428
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006429stats realm <realm>
6430 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006432 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006433 Arguments :
6434 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6435 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6436 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6437
6438 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6439 using a backslash ('\').
6440
6441 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6442 only related to authentication.
6443
6444 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6445 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6446 unobvious parameters.
6447
6448 Example :
6449 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6450 backend public_www
6451 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6452 stats enable
6453 stats hide-version
6454 stats scope .
6455 stats uri /admin?stats
6456 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6457 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6458 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6459
6460 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6461 backend private_monitoring
6462 stats enable
6463 stats uri /admin?stats
6464 stats refresh 5s
6465
6466 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6467
6468
6469stats refresh <delay>
6470 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006472 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006473 Arguments :
6474 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6475 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6476 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6477 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6478 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6479 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6480
6481 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6482 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6483 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6484 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6485
6486 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6487 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6488 unobvious parameters.
6489
6490 Example :
6491 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6492 backend public_www
6493 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6494 stats enable
6495 stats hide-version
6496 stats scope .
6497 stats uri /admin?stats
6498 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6499 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6500 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6501
6502 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6503 backend private_monitoring
6504 stats enable
6505 stats uri /admin?stats
6506 stats refresh 5s
6507
6508 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6509
6510
6511stats scope { <name> | "." }
6512 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006515 Arguments :
6516 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6517 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6518 section in which the statement appears.
6519
6520 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6521 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6522 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6523 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6524 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6525 exists.
6526
6527 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6528 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6529 unobvious parameters.
6530
6531 Example :
6532 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6533 backend public_www
6534 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6535 stats enable
6536 stats hide-version
6537 stats scope .
6538 stats uri /admin?stats
6539 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6540 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6541 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6542
6543 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6544 backend private_monitoring
6545 stats enable
6546 stats uri /admin?stats
6547 stats refresh 5s
6548
6549 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6550
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006551
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006552stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006553 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006555 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006556
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006557 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006558 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6559
6560 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6561 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6562
6563 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6564 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006565 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006566
6567 Example :
6568 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6569 backend private_monitoring
6570 stats enable
6571 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6572 stats uri /admin?stats
6573 stats refresh 5s
6574
6575 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6576 global section.
6577
6578
6579stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006580 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6582 yes | yes | yes | yes
6583 Arguments : none
6584
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006585 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006586 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6587 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6588 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6589 - IP (socket, server)
6590 - cookie (backend, server)
6591
6592 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6593 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006594 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006595
6596 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6597
6598
6599stats show-node [ <name> ]
6600 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006602 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006603 Arguments:
6604 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6605 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6606
6607 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6608 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006609 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006610
6611 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6612 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6613 unobvious parameters.
6614
6615 Example:
6616 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6617 backend private_monitoring
6618 stats enable
6619 stats show-node Europe-1
6620 stats uri /admin?stats
6621 stats refresh 5s
6622
6623 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6624 section.
6625
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006626
6627stats uri <prefix>
6628 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006630 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006631 Arguments :
6632 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6633 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6634 query string.
6635
6636 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6637 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6638 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6639 possible to reach it in the application.
6640
6641 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006642 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006643 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6644 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6645 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6646 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6647
6648 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6649 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6650 an address or a port to statistics only.
6651
6652 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6653 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6654 unobvious parameters.
6655
6656 Example :
6657 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6658 backend public_www
6659 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6660 stats enable
6661 stats hide-version
6662 stats scope .
6663 stats uri /admin?stats
6664 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6665 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6666 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6667
6668 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6669 backend private_monitoring
6670 stats enable
6671 stats uri /admin?stats
6672 stats refresh 5s
6673
6674 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6675
6676
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006677stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6678 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006680 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006681
6682 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006683 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006684 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6685 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6686 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6687
6688 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6689 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6690 the "stick-table" statement.
6691
6692 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6693 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6694 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6695 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6696 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6697
6698 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6699 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6700 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6701 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6702 transformation rules.
6703
6704 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6705 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6706 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6707 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6708 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6709 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6710 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6711
6712 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6713 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6714 ACL based conditions.
6715
6716 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6717 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6718 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6719 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6720
6721 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6722 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6723 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6724 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6725
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006726 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6727 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6728 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6729
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006730 Example :
6731 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6732 # last 30 minutes
6733 backend pop
6734 mode tcp
6735 balance roundrobin
6736 stick store-request src
6737 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6738 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6739 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6740
6741 backend smtp
6742 mode tcp
6743 balance roundrobin
6744 stick match src table pop
6745 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6746 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6747
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006748 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006749 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006750
6751
6752stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6753 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 no | no | yes | yes
6756
6757 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6758 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6759 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6760 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6761
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006762 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6763 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6764 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6765
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006766 Examples :
6767 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006768 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006769
6770 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6771 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6772 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6773
6774
6775 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6776 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6777 backend http
6778 mode http
6779 balance roundrobin
6780 stick on src table https
6781 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6782 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6783 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6784
6785 backend https
6786 mode tcp
6787 balance roundrobin
6788 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6789 stick on src
6790 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6791 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6792
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006793 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006794
6795
6796stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6797 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6799 no | no | yes | yes
6800
6801 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006802 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006803 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6804 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6805 server is selected.
6806
6807 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6808 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6809 the "stick-table" statement.
6810
6811 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6812 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6813 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6814 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6815 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6816 address.
6817
6818 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6819 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6820 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6821 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6822 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6823 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6824 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6825 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6826 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6827 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6828
6829 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6830 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6831 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6832 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6833 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6834 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6835 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6836
6837 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6838 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6839 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6840 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6841
6842 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6843 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6844 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6845 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6846 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6847 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006848 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6849 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6850 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6851 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6852 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6853 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006854
6855 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6856 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6857 the request.
6858
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006859 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6860 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6861 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6862
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006863 Example :
6864 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6865 # last 30 minutes
6866 backend pop
6867 mode tcp
6868 balance roundrobin
6869 stick store-request src
6870 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6871 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6872 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6873
6874 backend smtp
6875 mode tcp
6876 balance roundrobin
6877 stick match src table pop
6878 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6879 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6880
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006881 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006882 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006883
6884
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006885stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006886 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6887 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006888 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006890 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006891
6892 Arguments :
6893 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6894 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6895 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6896 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6897
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006898 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6899 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6900 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6901 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6902
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006903 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6904 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6905 instance.
6906
6907 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6908 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6909 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6910 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6911 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6912 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006913 to 32 characters.
6914
6915 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6916 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6917 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006918 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006919 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6920 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006921
6922 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006923 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6924 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006925 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6926 increase.
6927
6928 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006929 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6930 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6931 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006932
6933 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6934 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6935 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6936 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6937 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6938 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6939 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6940 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6941 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6942 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6943 parameter (see below).
6944
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006945 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6946 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6947 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6948 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6949 soft restart.
6950
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006951 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6952
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006953 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6954 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6955 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6956 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6957 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006958 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006959 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6960 if not expiration delay is specified.
6961
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006962 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6963 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6964 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6965 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006966 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6967 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6968 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6969 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6970 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6971 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6972 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6973 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6974 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6975 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6976 types and their arguments.
6977
6978 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6979 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6980 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6981 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6982
6983 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6984 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6985 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6986 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6987
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006988 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6989 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6990 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6991 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6992 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6993 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6994
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006995 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6996 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6997 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6998 they were received.
6999
7000 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7001 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7002 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7003 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7004 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7005
7006 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7007 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7008 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7009 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7010 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7011
7012 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7013 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7014 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7015
7016 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7017 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7018 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7019 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7020 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7021
7022 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7023 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7024 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7025 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7026 the client side.
7027
7028 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7029 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7030 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7031 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7032 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7033 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7034 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7035
7036 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7037 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7038 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7039 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7040 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7041 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7042 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7043
7044 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7045 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7046 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7047 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7048 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7049 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7050
7051 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7052 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7053 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7054 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7055
7056 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7057 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7058 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7059 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7060 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7061 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7062 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7063 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7064 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7065 recommended for better fairness.
7066
7067 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7068 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7069 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7070 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7071
7072 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7073 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7074 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7075 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7076 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7077 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7078 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7079 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7080 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7081 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007082
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007083 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7084 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007085 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7086 reference it.
7087
7088 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7089 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7090 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7091 as an exclusive stickiness.
7092
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007093 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7094 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7095 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7096 something that can be ignored.
7097
7098 Example:
7099 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7100 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7101 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7102 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7103
7104 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007105 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007106
7107
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007108stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7109 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7111 no | no | yes | yes
7112
7113 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007114 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007115 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7116 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7117 server is selected.
7118
7119 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7120 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7121 the "stick-table" statement.
7122
7123 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7124 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7125 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7126 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7127
7128 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7129 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7130 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7131 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7132 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7133 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007134 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007135 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7136 rules.
7137
7138 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7139 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7140 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7141 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7142 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7143 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7144 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7145
7146 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7147 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7148 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7149 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7150
7151 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7152 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7153 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7154 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7155 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7156 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007157 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7158 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7159 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7160 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7161 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7162 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7163 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7164 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7165 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007166
7167 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7168
7169 Example :
7170 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7171 backend https
7172 mode tcp
7173 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007174 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007175 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007176
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007177 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7178 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7179
7180 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7181 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7182 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7183
7184 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7185 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007186
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007187 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7188 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7189 # at offset 44.
7190
7191 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7192 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7193
7194 # Learn on response if server hello.
7195 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007196
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007197 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7198 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7199
7200 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7201 extraction.
7202
7203
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007204tcp-check connect [params*]
7205 Opens a new connection
7206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7207 no | no | yes | yes
7208
7209 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7210 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7211 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7212
7213 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7214 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7215 of the sequence.
7216
7217 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7218 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7219 do.
7220
7221 Parameters :
7222 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7223 use the TCP connection.
7224
7225 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7226 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7227 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7228
7229 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7230
7231 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7232
7233 Examples:
7234 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7235 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7236 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7237 option tcp-check
7238 tcp-check connect
7239 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7240 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7241 tcp-check send \r\n
7242 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7243 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7244 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7245 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7246 tcp-check send \r\n
7247 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7248 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7249
7250 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7251 option tcp-check
7252 tcp-check connect port 110
7253 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7254 tcp-check connect port 143
7255 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7256 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7257
7258 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7259
7260
7261tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7262 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7263 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7264 no | no | yes | yes
7265
7266 Arguments :
7267 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7268 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7269 binary.
7270 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7271 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7272 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7273
7274 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7275 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7276 with the usual backslash ('\').
7277 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7278 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7279 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7280 used upper or lower case.
7281
7282
7283 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7284
7285 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7286 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7287 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7288 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7289 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7290 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7291 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7292 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7293
7294 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7295 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7296 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7297 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7298 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7299 expression.
7300
7301 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7302 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7303 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7304 this exact hexadecimal string.
7305 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7306
7307 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7308 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7309 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7310 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7311 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7312 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7313 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7314 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7315 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7316 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7317 the null character.
7318
7319 Examples :
7320 # perform a POP check
7321 option tcp-check
7322 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7323
7324 # perform an IMAP check
7325 option tcp-check
7326 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7327
7328 # look for the redis master server
7329 option tcp-check
7330 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7331 tcp-check expect +PONG
7332 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7333 tcp-check expect string role:master
7334 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7335 tcp-check expect string +OK
7336
7337
7338 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7339 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7340
7341
7342tcp-check send <data>
7343 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7345 no | no | yes | yes
7346
7347 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7348 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7349
7350 Examples :
7351 # look for the redis master server
7352 option tcp-check
7353 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7354 tcp-check expect string role:master
7355
7356 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7357 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7358
7359
7360tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7361 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7362 tcp health check
7363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7364 no | no | yes | yes
7365
7366 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7367 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7368 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7369 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7370 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7371 hexadecimal string.
7372 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7373
7374 Examples :
7375 # redis check in binary
7376 option tcp-check
7377 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7378 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7379
7380
7381 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7382 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7383
7384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007385tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7386 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7388 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007389 Arguments :
7390 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007391 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7392 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007394 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007395
7396 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7397 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007398 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7399 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7400 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7401 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7402 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7403 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007404
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007405 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7406 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7407 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7408 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007409
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007410 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007411 - accept :
7412 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7413 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7414 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007415
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007416 - reject :
7417 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7418 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7419 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7420 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7421 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7422 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7423 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7424 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7425 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7426 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7427 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7428 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007429
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007430 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7431 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7432 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7433 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7434 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7435 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7436 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7437 hosts.
7438
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007439 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7440 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7441 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7442 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7443 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7444 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7445 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7446 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7447 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7448 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7449 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7450
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007451 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007452 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007453 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007454 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007455 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7456 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007457 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007458 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7459 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7460 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7461 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7462 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007463
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007464 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007465 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007466 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007467 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7468 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7469 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7470 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007472 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7473 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7474 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7475 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007477 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7478 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7479 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7480 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7481 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007482 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7483 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7484 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7485 layer7 information is extracted.
7486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7488 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7489 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7490 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7491 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007493 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7494 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7495 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007496
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007497 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7498 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7499 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007500
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007501 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007502 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007503 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007504
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007505 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7506 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7507 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007509 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007510 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7511 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007512
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007513 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7514
7515 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7516
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007517 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007519 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007520
7521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007522tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7523 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007525 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007526 Arguments :
7527 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007528 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007529 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7530 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007532 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007534 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7535 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7536 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7537 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7538 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007540 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7541 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7542 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7543 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007544 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7545 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7546 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7547 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7548 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7549 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007550 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007551 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7554 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7555 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7556 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007557
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007558 Four types of actions are supported :
7559 - accept : the request is accepted
7560 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7561 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007562 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007563
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007564 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7565 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007566
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007567 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7568 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7569 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7570 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7571 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7572 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007574 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007575 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7576 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007578 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007579 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7580 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7581 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7582 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007583 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7584 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7585 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007586
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007587 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007588 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7589 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7590 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007591
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007592 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007593 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7594 # and reject everything else.
7595 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7596 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007597 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007598 tcp-request content reject
7599
7600 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007601 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7602 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7603 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007604 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007605
7606 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7607 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7608 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007609 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007610 tcp-request content reject
7611
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007612 Example:
7613 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7614 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007615 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007616
7617 Example:
7618 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7619 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007620 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007622 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7623 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7624
7625 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007626 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007627 # protecting all our sites
7628 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007629 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7630 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007631 ...
7632 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7633
7634 backend http_dynamic
7635 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007636 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007637 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007638 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7639 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7640 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007641 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007643 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007644
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007645 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007646
7647
7648tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7649 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007651 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007652 Arguments :
7653 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7654 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7655 as explained at the top of this document.
7656
7657 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7658 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7659 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7660 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7661 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7662
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007663 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7664 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7665 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7666 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7667
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007668 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7669 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007670 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007671 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007672 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7673 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7674 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7675 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007676
7677 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7678 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7679 it pass through unaffected.
7680
7681 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7682 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7683 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007684 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007685 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7686 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007687 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7688 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7689 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007690
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007691 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007692 "timeout client".
7693
7694
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007695tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7696 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7698 no | no | yes | yes
7699 Arguments :
7700 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007701 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007702
7703 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7704
7705 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7706 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7707 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007708 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7709 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007710
7711 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7712
7713 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7714 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7715 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7716 inserted.
7717
7718 Two types of actions are supported :
7719 - accept :
7720 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7721 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7722 the rules evaluation.
7723
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007724 - close :
7725 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7726 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7727 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7728 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7729 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7730 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007731 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007732 protocols.
7733
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007734 - reject :
7735 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7736 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007737 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007738
7739 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7740 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7741 for changing the default action to a reject.
7742
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007743 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7744 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7745 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7746 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007747 period.
7748
7749 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7750
7751 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7752
7753
7754tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7755 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7757 no | no | yes | yes
7758 Arguments :
7759 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7760 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7761 as explained at the top of this document.
7762
7763 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7764
7765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007766timeout check <timeout>
7767 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7768 established.
7769
7770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7771 yes | no | yes | yes
7772 Arguments:
7773 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7774 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7775 as explained at the top of this document.
7776
7777 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7778 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7779 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7780 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007781 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7782 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7783 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007784
7785 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7786 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7787
7788 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7789 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007790 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007791
7792 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7793 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7794 forget about it.
7795
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007796 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7797 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007798
7799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007800timeout client <timeout>
7801timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7802 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7804 yes | yes | yes | no
7805 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007806 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7808 as explained at the top of this document.
7809
7810 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7811 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7812 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7813 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7814 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7815 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7816 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7817 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007818 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007819 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007820 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7821 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007822 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7823 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007824
7825 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7826 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7827 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7828 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7829 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7830 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7831
7832 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7833 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7834 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7835
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007836 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007837
7838
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007839timeout client-fin <timeout>
7840 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7842 yes | yes | yes | no
7843 Arguments :
7844 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7845 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7846 as explained at the top of this document.
7847
7848 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7849 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7850 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7851 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7852 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7853 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7854 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7855 down in one direction.
7856
7857 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7858 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7859 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7860
7861 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7862
7863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007864timeout connect <timeout>
7865timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7866 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7868 yes | no | yes | yes
7869 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007870 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007871 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7872 as explained at the top of this document.
7873
7874 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007875 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007876 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007877 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007878 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7879 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007880
7881 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7882 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7883 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7884 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7885 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7886 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7887
7888 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7889 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7890 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7891
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007892 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7893 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007894
7895
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007896timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7897 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 yes | yes | yes | yes
7900 Arguments :
7901 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7902 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7903 as explained at the top of this document.
7904
7905 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7906 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7907 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7908 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7909 once the request has started to present itself.
7910
7911 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7912 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7913 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7914 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7915 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7916
7917 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7918 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7919 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7920 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7921
7922 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7923 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7924 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7925 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7926 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007927 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007928
7929 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7930 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7931 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7932 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7933
7934 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7935
7936
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007937timeout http-request <timeout>
7938 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007940 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007941 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007942 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007943 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7944 as explained at the top of this document.
7945
7946 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7947 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7948 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7949 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7950 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7951 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7952 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007953 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7954 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7955 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7956 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7957 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7958 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7959 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007960
7961 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7962 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007963 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7964 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007965
7966 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7967 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7968 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7969 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7970 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7971
7972 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007973 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7974 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7975 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007976
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007977 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007978
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007979
7980timeout queue <timeout>
7981 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7983 yes | no | yes | yes
7984 Arguments :
7985 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7986 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7987 as explained at the top of this document.
7988
7989 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7990 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7991 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7992 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7993 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7994
7995 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7996 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7997 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7998 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7999
8000 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8001
8002
8003timeout server <timeout>
8004timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8005 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8007 yes | no | yes | yes
8008 Arguments :
8009 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8010 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8011 as explained at the top of this document.
8012
8013 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8014 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8015 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8016 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8017 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8018 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8019 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8020
8021 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8022 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8023 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8024 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8025 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008026 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008027 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008028 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8029 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8030 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8031 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008032
8033 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8034 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8035 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8036 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8037 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8038 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8039
8040 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8041 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8042 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8043
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008044 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008045
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008046
8047timeout server-fin <timeout>
8048 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8050 yes | no | yes | yes
8051 Arguments :
8052 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8053 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8054 as explained at the top of this document.
8055
8056 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8057 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8058 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8059 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8060 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8061 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8062 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8063 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8064 situations, it should not be needed.
8065
8066 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8067 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8068 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8069
8070 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8071
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008072
8073timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008074 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8076 yes | yes | yes | yes
8077 Arguments :
8078 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8079 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8080 as explained at the top of this document.
8081
8082 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8083 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8084 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8085
8086 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8087 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8088 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8089 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008090 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008091
8092 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8093
8094
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008095timeout tunnel <timeout>
8096 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8098 yes | no | yes | yes
8099 Arguments :
8100 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8101 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8102 as explained at the top of this document.
8103
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008104 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008105 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8106 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8107 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8108 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8109 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8110 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8111 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8112 specified.
8113
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008114 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8115 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8116 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8117 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8118 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8119 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8120 state.
8121
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008122 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8123 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8124 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8125 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8126 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8127
8128 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8129 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8130 forget about it.
8131
8132 Example :
8133 defaults http
8134 option http-server-close
8135 timeout connect 5s
8136 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008137 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008138 timeout server 30s
8139 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8140
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008141 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008142
8143
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008144transparent (deprecated)
8145 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008147 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008148 Arguments : none
8149
8150 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8151 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8152 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8153 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8154 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8155 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8156 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8157 appropriate server.
8158
8159 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8160
8161 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8162 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8163
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008164 See also: "option transparent"
8165
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008166unique-id-format <string>
8167 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8169 yes | yes | yes | no
8170 Arguments :
8171 <string> is a log-format string.
8172
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008173 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8174 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8175 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8176 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008177
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008178 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8179 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8180 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8181 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8182 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8183 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8184 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8185 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008186
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008187 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8188 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008189
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008190 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008191
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008192 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008193
8194 will generate:
8195
8196 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8197
8198 See also: "unique-id-header"
8199
8200unique-id-header <name>
8201 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8203 yes | yes | yes | no
8204 Arguments :
8205 <name> is the name of the header.
8206
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008207 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8208 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008209
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008210 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008211
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008212 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008213 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8214
8215 will generate:
8216
8217 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8218
8219 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008220
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008221use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008222 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8224 no | yes | yes | no
8225 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008226 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8227 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008228
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008229 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8230 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008231
8232 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8233 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8234 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008235 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8236 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8237 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8238 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008239
8240 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8241 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8242 assign the backend.
8243
8244 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8245 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8246 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8247 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8248 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8249 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8250
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008251 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008252 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008253 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8254 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8255 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8256
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008257 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8258 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8259 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8260 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8261 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8262 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8263 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8264 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8265 cannot be forced from the request.
8266
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008267 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008268 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8269 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8270
8271 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8272 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008273
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008274
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008275use-server <server> if <condition>
8276use-server <server> unless <condition>
8277 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8279 no | no | yes | yes
8280 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008281 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008282
8283 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8284
8285 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8286 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8287 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8288
8289 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8290 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8291 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8292 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8293 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8294 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8295 matches will assign the server.
8296
8297 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8298 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8299 with the next rules until one matches.
8300
8301 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8302 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8303 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8304 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8305
8306 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8307 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8308 stripped.
8309
8310 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8311 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8312 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8313 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8314
8315 Example :
8316 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8317 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8318 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8319 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8320 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8321 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8322 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8323 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8324 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8325
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008326 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008327
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008328
83295. Bind and Server options
8330--------------------------
8331
8332The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8333depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8334settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8335written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8336described in this section.
8337
8338
83395.1. Bind options
8340-----------------
8341
8342The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8343as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8344no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8345parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8346while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8347provided immediately after the setting name.
8348
8349The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8350
8351accept-proxy
8352 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008353 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8354 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008355 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8356 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8357 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8358 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8359 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8360 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8361 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008362 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8363 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008364
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008365alpn <protocols>
8366 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8367 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8368 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8369 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8370 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8371 initial NPN extension.
8372
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008373backlog <backlog>
8374 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8375 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8376
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008377ecdhe <named curve>
8378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008379 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8380 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008381
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008382ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8384 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8385 client's certificate.
8386
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008387ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8388 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8389 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8390 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8391 error is ignored.
8392
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008393ciphers <ciphers>
8394 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8395 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008396 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008397 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8398 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8399
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008400crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008401 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8402 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8403 to verify client's certificate.
8404
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008405crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8407 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8408 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8409 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8410 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8411 file.
8412
8413 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8414 are loaded.
8415
8416 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008417 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8418 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008419 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8420 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8421 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8422 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8423 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8424 www.sub.example.org).
8425
8426 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8427 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8428 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8429 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8430 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8431
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008432 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008433
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008434 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8435 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008436 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008437 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8438 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8439 clients).
8440
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008441 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8442 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8443 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8444 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8445 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8446 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8447 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8448 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8449 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8450 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8451 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8452 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8453 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8454
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008455crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8457 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008458 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008459 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008460
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008461crt-list <file>
8462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008463 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8464 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008465
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008466 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008467
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008468 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8469 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8470 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8471 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8472 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8473 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8474 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8475 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008476
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008477defer-accept
8478 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8479 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8480 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8481 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8482 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8483 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8484 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8485 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8486 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8487 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8488 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8489
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008490force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008491 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008492 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8493 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8494
8495force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008496 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008497 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8498
8499force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008500 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008501 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8502
8503force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008504 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008505 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8506
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008507gid <gid>
8508 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8509 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8510 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8511 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8512 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8513
8514group <group>
8515 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8516 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8517 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8518 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8519 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8520
8521id <id>
8522 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8523 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8524 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8525 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8526
8527interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008528 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8529 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8530 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8531 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8532 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8533 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8534 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008535
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008536level <level>
8537 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8538 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8539 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8540 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8541 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8542 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8543 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8544 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8545 counters).
8546 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8547 all counters).
8548
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008549maxconn <maxconn>
8550 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8551 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8552 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8553 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8554 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8555 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8556 eat all memory.
8557
8558mode <mode>
8559 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8560 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8561 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8562 UNIX sockets.
8563
8564mss <maxseg>
8565 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8566 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8567 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8568 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8569 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8570 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8571 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8572 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8573 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8574 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8575 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8576
8577name <name>
8578 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8579 page.
8580
8581nice <nice>
8582 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8583 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8584 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8585 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8586 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8587 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8588 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8589 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8590 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8591 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8592 one for an RDP socket.
8593
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008594no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008595 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008596 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008597 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008598 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8599 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008600
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008601no-tls-tickets
8602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8603 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8604 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8605 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8606
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008607no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008609 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008610 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8611 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8612 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008613
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008614no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008616 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008617 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8618 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8619 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008620
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008621no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008623 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008624 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8625 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8626 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008627
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008628npn <protocols>
8629 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8630 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8631 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8632 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008633 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8634 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008635
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008636process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8637 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8638 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8639 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8640 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8641 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8642 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8643 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008644 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8645 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8646 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8647 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8648 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8649 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8650 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008651
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008652ssl
8653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008654 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008655 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8656 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8657 to deciphered contents.
8658
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008659strict-sni
8660 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8661 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8662 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8663 See the "crt" option for more information.
8664
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008665tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008666 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008667 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8668 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8669 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8670 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8671 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8672 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8673 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008674 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8675 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8676 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008678transparent
8679 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8680 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8681 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8682 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8683 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8684 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8685 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8686 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8687 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8688 so check for support with your vendor.
8689
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008690v4v6
8691 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8692 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8693 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8694 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008695 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008696
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008697v6only
8698 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8699 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8700 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008701 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8702 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008703
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008704uid <uid>
8705 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8706 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8707 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8708 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8709 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8710
8711user <user>
8712 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8713 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8714 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8715 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8716 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8717
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008718verify [none|optional|required]
8719 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8720 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8721 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8722 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8723 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008724 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8725 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8726 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8727 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008728
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020087295.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008730------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008732The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8733which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8734arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8735settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8736after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8737Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8738address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008740 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008741 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008743The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008744
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008745addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008746 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8747 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8748 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8749 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8750 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008752 Supported in default-server: No
8753
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008754agent-check
8755 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008756 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8757 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8758 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8759 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008760
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008761 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008762 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008763 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8764 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8765 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008766
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008767 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8768 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008769
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008770 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8771 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8772 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008773
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008774 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8775 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8776 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008777
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008778 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8779 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8780 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8781 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8782 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8783 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8784 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008785
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008786 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8787 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008788
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008789 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8790 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8791 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8792 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8793 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8794 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8795 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8796 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8797 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008798
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008799 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8800 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008801 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8802 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8803 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8804 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008805
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008806 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8807 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008808
8809 Supported in default-server: No
8810
8811agent-inter <delay>
8812 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8813 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8814
8815 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8816 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8817 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8818 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8819 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8820 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8821 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8822 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8823 of backends use the same servers.
8824
8825 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8826
8827 Supported in default-server: Yes
8828
8829agent-port <port>
8830 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8831
8832 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8833
8834 Supported in default-server: Yes
8835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008836backup
8837 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8838 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8839 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8840 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8841 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8842 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008843
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008844 Supported in default-server: No
8845
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008846ca-file <cafile>
8847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8848 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8849 server's certificate.
8850
8851 Supported in default-server: No
8852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008853check
8854 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008855 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8856 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8857 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8858 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8859 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8860 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8861 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008862 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8863 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8864 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008866 Supported in default-server: No
8867
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008868check-send-proxy
8869 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8870 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8871 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8872 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8873 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8874 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8875 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8876
8877 Supported in default-server: No
8878
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008879check-ssl
8880 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8881 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8882 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8883 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008884 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008885 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8886 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8887 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8888 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8889
8890 Supported in default-server: No
8891
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008892ciphers <ciphers>
8893 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008894 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008895 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8896 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8897 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8898 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8899 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8900 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8901
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008902 Supported in default-server: No
8903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008904cookie <value>
8905 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8906 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8907 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8908 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8909 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8910 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8911 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008913 Supported in default-server: No
8914
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008915crl-file <crlfile>
8916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8917 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8918 to verify server's certificate.
8919
8920 Supported in default-server: No
8921
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008922crt <cert>
8923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8924 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8925 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8926 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8927 certificate request.
8928
8929 Supported in default-server: No
8930
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008931disabled
8932 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8933 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8934 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8935 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8936 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8937
8938 Supported in default-server: No
8939
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008940error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008941 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8942 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8943 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008945 Supported in default-server: Yes
8946
8947 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008949fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008950 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8951 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8952 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008954 Supported in default-server: Yes
8955
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008956force-sslv3
8957 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8958 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8959 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8960
8961 Supported in default-server: No
8962
8963force-tlsv10
8964 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8965 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8966
8967 Supported in default-server: No
8968
8969force-tlsv11
8970 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8971 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8972
8973 Supported in default-server: No
8974
8975force-tlsv12
8976 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8977 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8978
8979 Supported in default-server: No
8980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008981id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008982 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8983 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8984 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008986 Supported in default-server: No
8987
8988inter <delay>
8989fastinter <delay>
8990downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008991 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8992 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8993 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8994 between checks depending on the server state :
8995
8996 Server state | Interval used
8997 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8998 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8999 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9000 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9001 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9002 or yet unchecked. |
9003 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9004 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9005 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009007 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9008 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9009 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9010 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009011 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9012 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9013 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9014 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9015 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009017 Supported in default-server: Yes
9018
9019maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009020 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9021 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9022 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9023 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9024 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9025 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9026 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9027 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009029 Supported in default-server: Yes
9030
9031maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009032 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9033 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9034 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9035 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9036 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9037 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9038 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009040 Supported in default-server: Yes
9041
9042minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009043 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9044 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9045 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9046 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9047 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9048 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009049 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009050 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009052 Supported in default-server: Yes
9053
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009054no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009055 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9056 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009057 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009058
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009059 Supported in default-server: No
9060
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009061no-tls-tickets
9062 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9063 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9064 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
9065 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
9066
9067 Supported in default-server: No
9068
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009069no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009070 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009071 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9072 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009073 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9074 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009075
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009076 Supported in default-server: No
9077
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009078no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009079 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009080 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9081 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009082 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9083 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009084
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009085 Supported in default-server: No
9086
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009087no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009088 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009089 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9090 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009091 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9092 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009093
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009094 Supported in default-server: No
9095
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009096non-stick
9097 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9098 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9099 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9100
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009101 Supported in default-server: No
9102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009103observe <mode>
9104 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9105 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9106 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9107 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9108 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9109 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009110 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009112 Supported in default-server: No
9113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009114 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009116on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009117 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9118 Currently, four modes are available:
9119 - fastinter: force fastinter
9120 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9121 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9122 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9123 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009125 Supported in default-server: Yes
9126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009127 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9128
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009129on-marked-down <action>
9130 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9131 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009132 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9133 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9134 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9135 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9136 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9137 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9138 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9139 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009140
9141 Actions are disabled by default
9142
9143 Supported in default-server: Yes
9144
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009145on-marked-up <action>
9146 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9147 Currently one action is available:
9148 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9149 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9150 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9151 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9152 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9153 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9154 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9155 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9156
9157 Actions are disabled by default
9158
9159 Supported in default-server: Yes
9160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009161port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009162 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9163 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9164 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9165 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9166 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9167 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009169 Supported in default-server: Yes
9170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009171redir <prefix>
9172 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9173 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9174 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9175 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9176 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9177 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9178 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9179 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009180 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009181 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9182 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9183 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9184 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9185 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9186
9187 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009189 Supported in default-server: No
9190
9191rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009192 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9193 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9194 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009196 Supported in default-server: Yes
9197
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009198send-proxy
9199 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9200 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9201 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9202 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9203 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9204 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9205 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9206 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9207 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009208 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9209 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9210 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9211 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9212 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009213
9214 Supported in default-server: No
9215
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009216send-proxy-v2
9217 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9218 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9219 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9220 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9221 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9222 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9223 option of the "bind" keyword.
9224
9225 Supported in default-server: No
9226
9227send-proxy-v2-ssl
9228 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9229 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9230 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9231 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9232 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9233 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9234 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9235 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9236
9237 Supported in default-server: No
9238
9239send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9240 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9241 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9242 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9243 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9244 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9245 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9246 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9247 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9248 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9249
9250 Supported in default-server: No
9251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009252slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009253 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9254 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9255 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9256 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9257 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9258 parameters :
9259
9260 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9261 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9262
9263 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9264 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9265 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9266 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9267
9268 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9269 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9270 seen as failed.
9271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009272 Supported in default-server: Yes
9273
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009274source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009275source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009276source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009277 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9278 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9279 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9280 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9281
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009282 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9283 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9284 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9285 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9286 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9287 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9288 server.
9289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009290 Supported in default-server: No
9291
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009292ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009293 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9294 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9295 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9296 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9297 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9298 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009299 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009300
9301 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009303track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009304 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9305 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9306 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9307 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009308 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009310 Supported in default-server: No
9311
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009312verify [none|required]
9313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009314 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9315 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9316 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9317 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009318 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9319 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9320 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009321
9322 Supported in default-server: No
9323
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009324verifyhost <hostname>
9325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9326 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9327 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9328 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9329 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9330 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9331
9332 Supported in default-server: No
9333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009334weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009335 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9336 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9337 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009338 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9339 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9340 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9341 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9342 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9343 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009345 Supported in default-server: Yes
9346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009347
93486. HTTP header manipulation
9349---------------------------
9350
9351In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9352response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9353request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9354which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009355against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009356
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009357If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9358to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9359but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9360HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9361stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9362because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9363a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9364still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009366This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9367in section 4.2 :
9368
9369 - reqadd <string>
9370 - reqallow <search>
9371 - reqiallow <search>
9372 - reqdel <search>
9373 - reqidel <search>
9374 - reqdeny <search>
9375 - reqideny <search>
9376 - reqpass <search>
9377 - reqipass <search>
9378 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9379 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9380 - reqtarpit <search>
9381 - reqitarpit <search>
9382 - rspadd <string>
9383 - rspdel <search>
9384 - rspidel <search>
9385 - rspdeny <search>
9386 - rspideny <search>
9387 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9388 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9389
9390With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9391is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9392parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9393prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9394Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9395
9396 \t for a tab
9397 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9398 \n for a new line (LF)
9399 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9400 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9401 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9402 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9403 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9404
9405The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9406portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9407above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9408regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
94099 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9410is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9411
9412The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9413after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9414
9415Notes related to these keywords :
9416---------------------------------
9417 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9418 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9419 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9420
9421 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9422 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9423 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9424
9425 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9426 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9427 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9428 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9429 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9430
9431 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9432 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9433 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9434 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9435 useless headers before adding new ones.
9436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009437 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009438 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9439
9440 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9441 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9442 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9443
9444 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9445 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009446 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009447
9448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094497. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9450----------------------------------
9451
9452Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9453client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9454The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9455these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9456but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9457data called patterns.
9458
9459
94607.1. ACL basics
9461---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009462
9463The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9464content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9465from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9466simple :
9467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009469 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009470 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9471 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009473The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9474adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009475
9476In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009478 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009479
9480This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9481Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9482and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009483an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9484conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9485as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9486are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009487
9488ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9489'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9490which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9491
9492There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9493performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009495The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9496specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9497this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009498methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9499ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009500
9501Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9502 - boolean
9503 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9504 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9505 - string
9506 - data block
9507
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009508Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9509converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9510would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9511The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9512which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9513
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009514Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9515keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9516fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9517which are summarized in the table below :
9518
9519 +---------------------+-----------------+
9520 | Sample or converter | Default |
9521 | output type | matching method |
9522 +---------------------+-----------------+
9523 | boolean | bool |
9524 +---------------------+-----------------+
9525 | integer | int |
9526 +---------------------+-----------------+
9527 | ip | ip |
9528 +---------------------+-----------------+
9529 | string | str |
9530 +---------------------+-----------------+
9531 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9532 +---------------------+-----------------+
9533
9534Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9535matching method, see below.
9536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009537The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9538 - boolean
9539 - integer or integer range
9540 - IP address / network
9541 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9542 - regular expression
9543 - hex block
9544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009545The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9546
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009547 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9548 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009549 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009550 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009551 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009552 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009553 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9556read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9557if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9558lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9559will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9560beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9561a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9562lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9563exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9564
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009565The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9566parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9567ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9568a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9569check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9570
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009571The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9572socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9573file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009575Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9576loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9577
9578 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9579
9580In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9581the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9582case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9583as well.
9584
9585The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9586sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9587do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9588methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9589is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9590obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9591followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9592default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9593that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9594string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9595
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009596The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9597By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9598string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9599resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9600server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9601waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9602flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9603function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9606sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9607be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009608
9609 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9610 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009611 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9612 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9613 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9614 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009615
9616 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9617 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009618 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009619
9620 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009621 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009622
9623 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009624 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009625
9626 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9627 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9628
9629 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9630 binary or string samples.
9631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009632 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9633 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9636 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9637 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9640 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009642 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9643 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9646 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009648 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9649 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009650 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009652 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9653 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9654 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009655
9656For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9657request, it is possible to do :
9658
9659 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9660
9661In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9662buffer, one would use the following acl :
9663
9664 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9665
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009666On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9667possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9668
9669 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009671All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9672criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9673method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9674to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9675criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9676the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009678If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009679the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9680For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009682 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9683 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9684 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9685 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009686
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009687
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009688The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9689types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9690combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9691brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9692default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009694 +-------------------------------------------------+
9695 | Input sample type |
9696 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009697 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009698 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9699 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9700 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009701 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009702 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009703 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009704 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009705 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009706 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009707 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009709 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009711 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009713 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009715 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009717 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009719 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009721 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9723 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009725
9726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097277.1.1. Matching booleans
9728------------------------
9729
9730In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9731Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9732When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9733that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9734
9735Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9736return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9737"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097407.1.2. Matching integers
9741------------------------
9742
9743Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9744enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9745to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9746
9747Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9748matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9749lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009750
9751For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9752unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9753representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9754
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009755As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9756two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9757instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9758ranges and operators.
9759
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009760For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009761operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9762Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9763of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009764
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009765Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009766
9767 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9768 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9769 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9770 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9771 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009773For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009774
9775 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9776
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009777This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9778
9779 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9780
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097827.1.3. Matching strings
9783-----------------------
9784
9785String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9786different forms :
9787
9788 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9789 patterns ;
9790
9791 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9792 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9793
9794 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9795 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9796
9797 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9798 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9799
9800 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9801 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9802 matches.
9803
9804 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9805 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9806 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009807
9808String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9809exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9810characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9811string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9812to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009813before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009814
9815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098167.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9817---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009818
9819Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9820they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9821possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9822passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9823the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009824the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9825match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009826
9827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098287.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9829-------------------------------------
9830
9831It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9832not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9833a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9834to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9835digits may be used upper or lower case.
9836
9837Example :
9838 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9839 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9840
9841
98427.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9843---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009844
9845IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9846netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9847within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009848host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009849difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9850at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9851does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9852parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009853
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009854IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9855Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9856trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9857IPv6 patterns.
9858
9859HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9860following situations :
9861 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9862 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9863 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9864 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9865 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9866 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9867 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9868 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9869 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9870 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009872
98737.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9874----------------------------------
9875
9876Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9877combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9878
9879 - AND (implicit)
9880 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9881 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009883A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009885 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009887Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9888indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009890For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9891"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9892requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9893is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9894
9895 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9896 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9897 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9898 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9899
9900To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9901and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9902
9903 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9904 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9905 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9906 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9907
9908 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9909 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9910 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9911 use_backend www if host_www
9912
9913It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9914expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9915be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9916the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9917
9918 The following rule :
9919
9920 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9921 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9922
9923 Can also be written that way :
9924
9925 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9926
9927It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9928to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9929simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9930sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9931good use is the following :
9932
9933 With named ACLs :
9934
9935 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9936 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9937 monitor fail if site_dead
9938
9939 With anonymous ACLs :
9940
9941 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9942
9943See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9944
9945
99467.3. Fetching samples
9947---------------------
9948
9949Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9950against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9951sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9952ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9953of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9954available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9955
9956This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9957Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9958compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9959deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9960
9961The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9962matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9963method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9964indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9965
9966As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9967when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9968mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9969the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9970ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9971
9972Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9973multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9974when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9975incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9976are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9977is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9978all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9979
9980Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9981 - name
9982 - name(arg1)
9983 - name(arg1,arg2)
9984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009985
99867.3.1. Converters
9987-----------------
9988
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009989Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9990of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9991is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9992was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9993has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9994unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9995
9996These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9997sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9998the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9999support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010001The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010002
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010003base64
10004 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10005 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10006 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10007
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010008djb2([<avalanche>])
10009 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10010 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10011 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10012 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10013 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10014 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10015 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10016 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10017 directive.
10018
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010019hex
10020 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10021 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10022 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10023 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010025http_date([<offset>])
10026 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10027 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10028 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10029 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10030 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10031 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010033in_table(<table>)
10034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10036 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10037 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10038 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10039
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010040ipmask(<mask>)
10041 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10042 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10043 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10044 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10045
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010046language(<value>[,<default>])
10047 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10048 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10049 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10050 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10051 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10052 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10053 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10054 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10055 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10056 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10057 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10058 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010059
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010060 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010061
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010062 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10063 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010064
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010065 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10066 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10067 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10068 use_backend spanish if es
10069 use_backend french if fr
10070 use_backend english if en
10071 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010072
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010073lower
10074 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10075 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10076 type. The result is of type string.
10077
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010078ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10079 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10080 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10081 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10082 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10083 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10084 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10085
10086 Example :
10087
10088 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10089 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10090 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10091
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010092map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10093map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10094map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10095 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10096 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10097 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10098 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10099 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10100 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10101 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10102 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010103
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010104 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10105 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10106 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010107
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010108 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10109 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010110
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010111 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10112 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10113 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10114 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010115 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10116 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010117 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10118 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10119 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10120 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10121 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10122 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10123 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10124 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10125 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10126 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10127 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10128 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10129 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10130 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010132 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10133 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10134 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10135 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10136 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010137
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010138 Example :
10139
10140 # this is a comment and is ignored
10141 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10142 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10143 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10144 | | | `---------- value
10145 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10146 | `---------------------------- key
10147 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10148
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010149sdbm([<avalanche>])
10150 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10151 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10152 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10153 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10154 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10155 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10156 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10157 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10158 directive.
10159
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010160table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10161 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10162 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10163 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10164 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10165 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10166 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10167
10168
10169table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10170 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10171 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10172 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10173 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10174 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10175 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10176
10177table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10178 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10179 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10180 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10181 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10182 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10183
10184table_conn_cur(<table>)
10185 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10186 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10187 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10188 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10189 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10190
10191table_conn_rate(<table>)
10192 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10193 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10194 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10195 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10196 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10197
10198table_gpc0(<table>)
10199 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10200 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10201 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10202 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10203 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10204
10205table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10206 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10207 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10208 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10209 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10210 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10211 sample fetch keyword.
10212
10213table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10214 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10215 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10216 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10217 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10218 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10219
10220table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10221 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10222 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10223 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10224 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10225 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10226 keyword.
10227
10228table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10229 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10230 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10231 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10232 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10233 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10234
10235table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10236 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10237 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10238 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10239 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10240 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10241 keyword.
10242
10243table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10244 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10245 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10246 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10247 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10248 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10249 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10250 keyword.
10251
10252table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10255 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10256 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10257 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10258 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10259 keyword.
10260
10261table_server_id(<table>)
10262 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10263 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10264 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10265 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10266 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10267 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10268
10269table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10270 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10271 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10272 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10273 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10274 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10275 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10276 keyword.
10277
10278table_sess_rate(<table>)
10279 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10280 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10281 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10282 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10283 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10284 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10285 keyword.
10286
10287table_trackers(<table>)
10288 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10289 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10290 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10291 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10292 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10293 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10294 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10295 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10296 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10297 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10298
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010299upper
10300 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10301 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10302 type. The result is of type string.
10303
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010304utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10305 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10306 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10307 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10308 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10309 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10310 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10311
10312 Example :
10313
10314 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10315 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10316 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10317
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010318wt6([<avalanche>])
10319 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10320 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10321 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10322 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10323 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10324 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10325 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10326 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "sdbm", and the "hash-type"
10327 directive.
10328
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010329
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200103307.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010331--------------------------------------------
10332
10333A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10334not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10335"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10336The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10337
10338always_false : boolean
10339 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10340 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10341
10342always_true : boolean
10343 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10344 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10345
10346avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010347 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010348 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10349 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10350 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10351 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10352 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10353 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10354 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10355 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10356 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10357 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10358 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10359 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10360 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010362be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010363 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10364 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10365 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10366 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10367 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010369be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10370 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10371 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10372 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10373 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10374 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10375 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010376
10377 Example :
10378 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10379 backend dynamic
10380 mode http
10381 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10382 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010384connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010386 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010387 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10388 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010389
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010390 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010391 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010392 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10393
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010394 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10395 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010396
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010397 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010398 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010400 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10401 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010402 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010403 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010404
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010405 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10406 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010407 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010408 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010409
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010410date([<offset>]) : integer
10411 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10412 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10413 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10414 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010415 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10416
10417 Example :
10418
10419 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10420 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010421
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010422env(<name>) : string
10423 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10424 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10425 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10426 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10427 certain way.
10428
10429 Examples :
10430 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10431 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10432
10433 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10434 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010436fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10437 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010438 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10439 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010440 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10441 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10442 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10443 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10444 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010446fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10447 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10448 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10449 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10450 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10451 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10452 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10453 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10454 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010455
10456 Example :
10457 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10458 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10459 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10460 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10461 frontend mail
10462 bind :25
10463 mode tcp
10464 maxconn 100
10465 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10466 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10467 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10468 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010470nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10471 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10472 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10473 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010474 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10475 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10476 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010478queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010479 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10480 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10481 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10483 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10484 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10485 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10486 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10487
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010488rand([<range>]) : integer
10489 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10490 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10491 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10492 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10493 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010495srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10497 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10498 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10499 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10500 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10501 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10502 methods.
10503
10504srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10505 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10506 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10507 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10508 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10509 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10510 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10511 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10512
10513srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10514 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10515 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010516 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010517 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10518 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10519 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10520 overloading servers).
10521
10522 Example :
10523 # Redirect to a separate back
10524 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10525 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10526 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10527
10528table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10529 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10530 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10531
10532table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10533 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10534 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10535 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10536
10537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200105387.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539----------------------------------
10540
10541The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10542closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10543methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10544sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10545TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010546the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10547counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10548"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010549argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10550the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10551this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010552
10553be_id : integer
10554 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10555 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10556
10557dst : ip
10558 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10559 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10560 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10561 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10562 RFC 4291.
10563
10564dst_conn : integer
10565 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10566 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10567 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10568 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10569 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10570 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10571 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10572 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574dst_port : integer
10575 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10576 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10577 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10578 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10579 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10580 an HTTP header.
10581
10582fe_id : integer
10583 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10584 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10585 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10586
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010587sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010588sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10589sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10590sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010591 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10592 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10593 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10594
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010595sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010596sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10597sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10598sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010599 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10600 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10601 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10602
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010603sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010604sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10605sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10606sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010607 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10608 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010609 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10610 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10611 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010612
10613 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10614 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010615 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10616 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10617 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010618 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10619 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10620
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010621sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010622sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10623sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10624sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010625 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10626 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10627
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010628sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010629sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10630sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10631sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010632 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10633 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10634 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10635
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010636sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010637sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10638sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10639sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010640 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10641 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10642 See also src_conn_rate.
10643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010644sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010645sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10646sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10647sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010648 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010649 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010650
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010651sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010652sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10653sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10654sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010655 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10656 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10657 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010658 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10659 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10660 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010662sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010663sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10664sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10665sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010666 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10667 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10668 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10669
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010670sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010671sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10672sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10673sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010674 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10675 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10676 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10677 src_http_err_rate.
10678
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010679sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010680sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10681sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10682sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010683 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10684 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10685 src_http_req_cnt.
10686
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010687sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010688sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10689sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10690sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010691 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10692 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10693 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10694 src_http_req_rate.
10695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010696sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010697sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10698sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10699sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010700 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010701 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10702 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10703 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10704 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010705
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010706 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10707 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010708 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010710sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010711sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10712sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10713sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010714 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10715 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10716 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010718sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010719sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10720sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10721sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010722 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10723 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10724 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010726sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010727sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10728sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10729sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010730 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10731 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10732 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10733 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010734 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010735 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10736
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010737sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010738sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10739sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10740sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010741 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10742 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10743 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10744 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10745 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010746 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010748sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010749sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10750sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10751sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010752 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10753 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10754 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010756sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010757sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10758sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10759sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010760 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10761 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010762 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010763 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10764 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010765 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10766 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10767 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769so_id : integer
10770 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10771 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10772 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010774src : ip
10775 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10776 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10777 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10778 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10779 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10780 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10781 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010782
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010783 Example:
10784 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10785 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010787src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10788 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10789 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10790 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010791 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010793src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10794 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10795 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010796 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010797 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010799src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10800 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10801 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10802 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10803 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10804 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10805 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010806
10807 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10808 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10809 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10810 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010811 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010812 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10813 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010815src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010816 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010817 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010818 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010819 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010821src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010822 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010823 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10824 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010825 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010827src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10828 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10829 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10830 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010831 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010833src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010834 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010835 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010836 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010837 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010839src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010840 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010841 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010842 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10843 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010844 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10845 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10846 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010848src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10849 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10850 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010851 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010852 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010853 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010855src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10856 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10857 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10858 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10859 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010860 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010862src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10863 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10864 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10865 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010866 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010868src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10869 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10870 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10871 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010872 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010873 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010875src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10876 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10877 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10878 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010879 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010880 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10881 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010882
10883 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010884 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010885 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010887src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010888 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10889 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10890 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10891 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10892 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010894src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010895 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10896 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10897 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10898 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10899 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010901src_port : integer
10902 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10903 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10904 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10905 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10908 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010909 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10910 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10911 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010912 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010914src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10915 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10916 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10917 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10918 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010919 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10922 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10923 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10924 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10925 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10926 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10927 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10928 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10929 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010930
10931 Example :
10932 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10933 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10934 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10935 listen ssh
10936 bind :22
10937 mode tcp
10938 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010939 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010941 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943srv_id : integer
10944 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10945 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10946 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010947
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010948
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109497.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010950----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010952The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10953closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10954when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10955usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010956future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010957
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010958ssl_bc : boolean
10959 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10960 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10961 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10962
10963ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10964 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10965 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10966
10967ssl_bc_cipher : string
10968 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10969 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10970
10971ssl_bc_protocol : string
10972 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10973 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10974
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010975ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010976 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010977 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10978 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010979
10980ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10981 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10982 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10983 if session was reused or not.
10984
10985ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10986 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10987 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010989ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10990 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10991 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10992 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10993 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10994 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010996ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10997 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10998 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10999 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11000 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011002ssl_c_err : integer
11003 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11004 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11005 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11006 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11007 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011009ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11010 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11011 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11012 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11013 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11014 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11015 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11016 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11017 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011019ssl_c_key_alg : string
11020 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11021 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11022 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011024ssl_c_notafter : string
11025 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11026 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11027 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011029ssl_c_notbefore : string
11030 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11031 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11032 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011034ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11035 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11036 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11037 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11038 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11039 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11040 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11041 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11042 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044ssl_c_serial : binary
11045 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11046 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11047 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011049ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11050 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11051 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11052 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011053 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11054 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11055
11056 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011058ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11059 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11060 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11061 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011063ssl_c_used : boolean
11064 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11065 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011067ssl_c_verify : integer
11068 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11069 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11070 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11071 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011073ssl_c_version : integer
11074 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11075 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011077ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11078 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11079 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11080 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11081 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011082 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11084 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11085 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011087ssl_f_key_alg : string
11088 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11089 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11090 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011092ssl_f_notafter : string
11093 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11094 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11095 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011097ssl_f_notbefore : string
11098 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11099 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11100 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011102ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11103 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11104 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11105 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11106 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11107 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11108 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11109 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11110 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011112ssl_f_serial : binary
11113 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11114 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11115 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011116
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011117ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11118 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11119 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11120 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11123 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11124 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11125 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011127ssl_f_version : integer
11128 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11129 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11130
11131ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011132 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11133 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11134 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136 Example :
11137 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11138 listen http-https
11139 bind :80
11140 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11141 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11142
11143ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11144 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11145 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11146
11147ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011148 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011149 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11150 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11151 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11152 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11153 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11154 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11155 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11156 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011158ssl_fc_cipher : string
11159 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11160 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011162ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011163 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11164 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011165 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11166 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11167 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11168 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11171 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011172 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11173 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11174 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11175 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011177ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011178 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011179 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11180 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11181 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11182 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11183 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11184 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11185 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187ssl_fc_protocol : string
11188 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11189 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011190
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011191ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011192 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011193 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11194 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011196ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11197 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11198 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11199 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11200 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011202ssl_fc_sni : string
11203 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11204 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11205 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11206 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11207 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11208
11209 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11210 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11211 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011212 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11213 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011215 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011216 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11217 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011219ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11220 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11221 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011222
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112247.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011225------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11228sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11229only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11230For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11231be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11232can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11233sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11234for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11235content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011237payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11238 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11239 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11240 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011242payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11243 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11244 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11245 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011247req.len : integer
11248req_len : integer (deprecated)
11249 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11250 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11251 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11252 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11253 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11254 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11255 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11256 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011258req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11259 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011260 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11261 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11262 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11263 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011265 ACL alternatives :
11266 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011268req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11269 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11270 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11271 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11272 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011274 ACL alternatives :
11275 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011277 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011279req.proto_http : boolean
11280req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11281 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11282 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11283 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11284 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11285 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11286 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11287 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011289 Example:
11290 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11291 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11292 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011293 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011295req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11296rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11297 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11298 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11299 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11300 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11301 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11302 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11303 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011305 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11306 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11307 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11308 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11309 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11310 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312 ACL derivatives :
11313 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011315 Example :
11316 listen tse-farm
11317 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11318 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11319 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11320 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11321 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11322 persist rdp-cookie
11323 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11324 # This is only useful makes sense if
11325 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11326 stick-table type string size 204800
11327 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11328 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11329 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11332 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011334req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11335rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11336 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11337 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11338 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11339 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341 ACL derivatives :
11342 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011344req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11345req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11346 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11347 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11348 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11349 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11350 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11351 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11352 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354req.ssl_sni : string
11355req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11356 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11357 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11358 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11359 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11360 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11361 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11362 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11363 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11364 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11365 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11366 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11367 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369 ACL derivatives :
11370 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011372 Examples :
11373 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11374 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11375 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11376 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11377 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011379res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11380rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11381 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11382 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11383 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11384 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11385 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11386 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11387 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011389req.ssl_ver : integer
11390req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11391 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11392 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11393 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11394 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11395 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11396 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11397 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11398 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11399 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011401 ACL derivatives :
11402 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011403
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011404res.len : integer
11405 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11406 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11407 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11408 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11409 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11410 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11411 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11412 content inspection.
11413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11415 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011416 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11417 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11418 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11419 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011421res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11422 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11423 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11424 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11425 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011427 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429wait_end : boolean
11430 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11431 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11432 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11433 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11434 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11435 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11436 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11437 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011439 Examples :
11440 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11441 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11442 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011444 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11445 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11446 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11447 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11448 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11449 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11450 tcp-request content reject
11451
11452
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114537.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011454--------------------------------------
11455
11456It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11457This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11458data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11459its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11460HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11461content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11462to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11463more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11464response are indexed.
11465
11466base : string
11467 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11468 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11469 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11470 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11471 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11472 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11473 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11474 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11475
11476 ACL derivatives :
11477 base : exact string match
11478 base_beg : prefix match
11479 base_dir : subdir match
11480 base_dom : domain match
11481 base_end : suffix match
11482 base_len : length match
11483 base_reg : regex match
11484 base_sub : substring match
11485
11486base32 : integer
11487 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11488 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11489 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011490 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11491 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11492 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493
11494base32+src : binary
11495 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11496 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11497 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11498 per-URL counters.
11499
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011500capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11501 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11502 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11503 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11504
11505capture.req.method : string
11506 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11507 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11508 because it's allocated.
11509
11510capture.req.uri : string
11511 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11512 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11513 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11514 allocated.
11515
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011516capture.req.ver : string
11517 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11518 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11519 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11520
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011521capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11522 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11523 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11524 The first entry is an index of 0.
11525 See also: "capture response header"
11526
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011527capture.res.ver : string
11528 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11529 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11530 persistent flag.
11531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011532req.cook([<name>]) : string
11533cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11534 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11535 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11536 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11537 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11538 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11539 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11540 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11541 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11542
11543 ACL derivatives :
11544 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11545 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11546 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11547 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11548 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11549 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11550 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11551 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011553req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11554cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11555 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11556 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011558req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11559cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11560 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11561 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11562 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11563 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11566 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11567 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11568 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11569 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11570 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11571 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11572 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11573 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11574 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11575 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011577hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11578 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11579 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11580 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11581 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011582 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11585 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11586 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11587 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11588 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11589 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11590 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11591 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11592 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11595 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11596 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11597 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11598 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011600req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11601 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11602 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11603 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11604 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11605 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11606 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11607 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11608 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11609 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11610 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11611 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613 ACL derivatives :
11614 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11615 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11616 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11617 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11618 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11619 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11620 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11621 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11622
11623req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11624hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11625 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11626 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11627 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11628 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11629 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11630 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11631 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11632 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11633 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11634
11635req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11636hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11637 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11638 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11639 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11640 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11641 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11642 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11643 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11644 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11645
11646req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11647hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11648 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11649 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11650 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11651 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11652 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11653 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11654 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11655
11656http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11657 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11658 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11659 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11660 basic auth is supported.
11661
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011662http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11663 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11664 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11665 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11666 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011667 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11668 basic auth is supported.
11669
11670 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011671 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11672 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11673 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11674 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011675
11676http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011677 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11678 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11680 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682method : integer + string
11683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11684 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11685 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11686 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11687 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11688 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11689 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011691 ACL derivatives :
11692 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694 Example :
11695 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11696 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11697 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699path : string
11700 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11701 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11702 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11703 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11704 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11705 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11706 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011708 ACL derivatives :
11709 path : exact string match
11710 path_beg : prefix match
11711 path_dir : subdir match
11712 path_dom : domain match
11713 path_end : suffix match
11714 path_len : length match
11715 path_reg : regex match
11716 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718req.ver : string
11719req_ver : string (deprecated)
11720 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11721 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11722 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724 ACL derivatives :
11725 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011727res.comp : boolean
11728 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11729 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11730 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011732res.comp_algo : string
11733 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11734 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11735 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011737res.cook([<name>]) : string
11738scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11739 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11740 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11741 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011743 ACL derivatives :
11744 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011746res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11747scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11748 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11749 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11750 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11753scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11754 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11755 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11756 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011758res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11759 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11760 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11761 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11762 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11763 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11764 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11765 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11766 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11767 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011769res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11770 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11771 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11772 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11773 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11774 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011776res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11777shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11778 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11779 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11780 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11781 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11782 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11783 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11784 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11785 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011787 ACL derivatives :
11788 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11789 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11790 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11791 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11792 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11793 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11794 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11795 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11796
11797res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11798shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11799 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11800 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11801 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11802 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11803 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011805res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11806shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11807 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11808 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11809 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11810 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11811 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11812 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011814res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11815shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11816 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11817 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11818 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11819 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11820 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11821 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011823res.ver : string
11824resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11825 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11826 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011828 ACL derivatives :
11829 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011831set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11832 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11833 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11834 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11835 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011837 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11838 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011840 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011842status : integer
11843 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11844 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11845 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847url : string
11848 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11849 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11850 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11851 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11852 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11853 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11854 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856 ACL derivatives :
11857 url : exact string match
11858 url_beg : prefix match
11859 url_dir : subdir match
11860 url_dom : domain match
11861 url_end : suffix match
11862 url_len : length match
11863 url_reg : regex match
11864 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011866url_ip : ip
11867 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11868 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11869 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11870 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11871 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11872 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11873 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011875url_port : integer
11876 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11877 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11878 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11879 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011881urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11882url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11883 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11884 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11885 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11886 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11887 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11888 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11889 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11890 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11891 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893 ACL derivatives :
11894 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11895 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11896 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11897 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11898 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11899 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11900 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11901 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011902
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011904 Example :
11905 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11906 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11907 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11908 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11911 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11912 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11913 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011914
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011917---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011919Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11920every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011921order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011923ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11924---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011925FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011926HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011927HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11928HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011929HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11930HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11931HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11932HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11933LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011934METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11935METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11936METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11937METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11938METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11939METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011940RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011941REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011942TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011943WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11944---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011945
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119478. Logging
11948----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011949
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011950One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11951provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11952very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11953provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11954state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011955to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011956headers.
11957
11958In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11959about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11960send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11961
11962 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11963 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11964 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11965 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11966 at the termination.
11967
11968The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11969allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11970as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11971while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11972real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11973delay.
11974
11975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119768.1. Log levels
11977---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011978
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011979TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011980source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011981HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11982in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11983track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11984syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11985about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011986
11987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119888.2. Log formats
11989----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011990
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011991HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011992and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11993slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11994options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011995
11996 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11997 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11998 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11999 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12000 extents.
12001
12002 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12003 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12004 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12005 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12006 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12007
12008 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12009 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12010 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12011 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12012 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12013
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012014 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12015 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12016 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12017 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12018
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012019 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12020
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012021Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12022specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12023field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12024servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12025always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12026identifier.
12027
12028Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12029 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12030 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12031 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12032 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12033
12034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120358.2.1. Default log format
12036-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012037
12038This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12039as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12040format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12041
12042 Example :
12043 listen www
12044 mode http
12045 log global
12046 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12047
12048 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12049 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12050 (www/HTTP)
12051
12052 Field Format Extract from the example above
12053 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12054 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12055 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12056 4 'to' to
12057 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12058 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12059
12060Detailed fields description :
12061 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12062 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12063 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12064 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12065 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12066 and processed the connection.
12067 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12068
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012069In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12070"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12071connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12072
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012073It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12074will eventually disappear.
12075
12076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120778.2.2. TCP log format
12078---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012079
12080The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12081is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12082information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12083counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12084emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12085environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12086the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12087sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012088specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12089not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12090fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12091marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012092
12093 Example :
12094 frontend fnt
12095 mode tcp
12096 option tcplog
12097 log global
12098 default_backend bck
12099
12100 backend bck
12101 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12102
12103 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12104 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12105 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12106
12107 Field Format Extract from the example above
12108 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12109 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12110 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12111 4 frontend_name fnt
12112 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12113 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12114 7 bytes_read* 212
12115 8 termination_state --
12116 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12117 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12118
12119Detailed fields description :
12120 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012121 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12122 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12123 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12124 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12125 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012126
12127 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012128 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12129 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12130 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012131
12132 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12133 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12134 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12135 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12136
12137 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12138 and processed the connection.
12139
12140 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12141 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12142 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12143 applications.
12144
12145 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12146 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12147 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12148 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12149 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12150
12151 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12152 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12153 See "Timers" below for more details.
12154
12155 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12156 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12157 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12158 "Timers" below for more details.
12159
12160 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012161 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012162 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12163 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12164 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12165 details.
12166
12167 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12168 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12169 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12170 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12171 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12172
12173 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12174 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12175 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12176 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12177 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12178 for more details.
12179
12180 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012181 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012182 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12183 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12184 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012185 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012186
12187 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12188 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12189 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12190 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12191 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12192 caused by a denial of service attack.
12193
12194 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12195 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12196 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12197 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12198 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12199 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12200 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12201 denial of service attack.
12202
12203 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12204 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12205 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12206 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12207 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12208 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12209 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12210 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12211 be processed than on other servers.
12212
12213 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12214 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12215 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12216 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12217 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12218 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12219 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12220 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12221 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12222 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12223 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12224 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12225 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12226
12227 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12228 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12229 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12230 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12231 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12232 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12233 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12234 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12235
12236 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12237 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12238 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12239 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12240 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12241 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12242 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12243 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12244 occurs.
12245
12246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122478.2.3. HTTP log format
12248----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012249
12250The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12251is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12252the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12253are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12254emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12255generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12256"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12257which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012258frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12259is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012260
12261Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12262slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12263with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12264
12265 Example :
12266 frontend http-in
12267 mode http
12268 option httplog
12269 log global
12270 default_backend bck
12271
12272 backend static
12273 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12274
12275 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12276 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12277 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012278 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012279
12280 Field Format Extract from the example above
12281 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12282 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12283 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12284 4 frontend_name http-in
12285 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12286 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12287 7 status_code 200
12288 8 bytes_read* 2750
12289 9 captured_request_cookie -
12290 10 captured_response_cookie -
12291 11 termination_state ----
12292 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12293 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12294 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12295 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12296 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012297
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012298
12299Detailed fields description :
12300 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012301 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12302 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12303 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12304 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12305 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012306
12307 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012308 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12309 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12310 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012311
12312 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12313 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12314 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12315 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12316 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12317
12318 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12319 and processed the connection.
12320
12321 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12322 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12323 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12324
12325 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12326 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12327 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12328 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12329 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12330 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12331
12332 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12333 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12334 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12335 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12336 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12337 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12338
12339 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12340 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12341 See "Timers" below for more details.
12342
12343 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12344 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12345 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12346 below for more details.
12347
12348 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12349 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12350 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12351 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12352 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12353 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12354 for more details.
12355
12356 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012357 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012358 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12359 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12360 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12361 details.
12362
12363 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12364 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12365 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12366
12367 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12368 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12369 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12370 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12371 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12372 overflowing.
12373
12374 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12375 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12376 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12377 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12378 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12379 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12380 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12381 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12382
12383 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12384 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12385 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12386 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12387 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12388 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12389 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12390 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12391
12392 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12393 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12394 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12395 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12396 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12397 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12398 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12399
12400 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012401 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012402 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12403 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12404 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012405 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012406 system.
12407
12408 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12409 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12410 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12411 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12412 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12413 caused by a denial of service attack.
12414
12415 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12416 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12417 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12418 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12419 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12420 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12421 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12422 denial of service attack.
12423
12424 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12425 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12426 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12427 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12428 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12429 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12430 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12431 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12432 processed than on other servers.
12433
12434 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12435 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12436 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12437 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12438 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12439 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12440 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12441 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12442 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12443 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12444 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12445 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12446 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12447
12448 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12449 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12450 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12451 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12452 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12453 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12454 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12455 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12456
12457 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12458 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12459 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12460 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12461 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12462 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12463 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12464 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12465 occurs.
12466
12467 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12468 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12469 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12470 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12471 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12472 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12473 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12474 cookies" below for more details.
12475
12476 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12477 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12478 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12479 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12480 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12481 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12482 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12483 and cookies" below for more details.
12484
12485 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12486 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12487 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12488 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12489 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12490 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12491 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12492 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12493
12494
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200124958.2.4. Custom log format
12496------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012497
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012498The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012499mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012500
12501HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12502Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12503separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12504prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12505
12506Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12507variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12508string formats ("Q").
12509
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012510If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012511as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012512less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12513the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12514
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012515Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012516In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012517in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012518
12519Flags are :
12520 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012521 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012522
12523 Example:
12524
12525 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12526 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12527
12528At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12529
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012530 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12531 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012532
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012533the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012534
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012535 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012536 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012537 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012538
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012539and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12540
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012541 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012542 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12543
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012544Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12545
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012546 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012547 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012548 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12549 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12550 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012551 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12552 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12553 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012554 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012555 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012556 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012557 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012558 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012559 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012560 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12561 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012562 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012563 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12564 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012565 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012566 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12567 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012568 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12569 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12570 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012571 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012572 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12573 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012574 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012575 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12576 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12577 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012578 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020012579 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012580 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12581 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12582 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12583 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012584 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012585 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012586 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012587 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012588 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012589 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012590 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12591 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12592 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012593 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012594 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12595 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012596 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012597 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012598 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012599 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012600
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012601 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012602
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012603
126048.2.5. Error log format
12605-----------------------
12606
12607When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12608protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12609By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12610"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12611will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12612logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12613
12614The format looks like this :
12615
12616 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12617 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12618 Connection error during SSL handshake
12619
12620 Field Format Extract from the example above
12621 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12622 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12623 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12624 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12625 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12626
12627These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12628failures.
12629
12630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126318.3. Advanced logging options
12632-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012633
12634Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12635just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12636options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12637for more information about their usage.
12638
12639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126408.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12641------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012642
12643It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12644haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12645commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12646monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12647ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12648
12649 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12650 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12651 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12652 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12653
12654 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12655 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12656 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012657 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012658 such as other load-balancers.
12659
12660 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12661 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12662 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12663
12664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126658.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12666----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012667
12668The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12669what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12670or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12671"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12672just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12673log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12674after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12675is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12676with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12677with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12678
12679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126808.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12681------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012682
12683Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12684for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12685"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12686retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12687raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12688a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12689file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12690you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12691"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12692
12693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12695--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012696
12697Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12698multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12699them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12700"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12701logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12702error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12703and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12704too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12705useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12706alternative.
12707
12708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127098.4. Timing events
12710------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012711
12712Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12713reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12714the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12715frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12716mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12717
12718 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12719 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12720 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12721 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12722 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12723
12724 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12725 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12726 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12727 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12728 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12729
12730 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12731 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12732 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12733 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12734 connection never established.
12735
12736 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12737 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12738 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12739 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12740 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12741 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12742 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12743 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12744 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12745 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12746 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12747
12748 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12749 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12750 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12751 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012752 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012753
12754 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12755
12756 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12757 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12758 negative.
12759
12760These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12761protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12762that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012763due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012764close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12765session has been aborted on timeout.
12766
12767Most common cases :
12768
12769 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12770 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12771 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12772 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12773 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12774 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12775 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12776 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12777 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012778 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12779 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12780 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012781
12782 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12783 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12784 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12785 of ms on remote networks.
12786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012787 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12788 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12789 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012790
12791 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12792 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12793 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12794 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12795 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12796 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12797 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12798 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12799 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12800 to the server until another one is released.
12801
12802Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12803
12804 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12805 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12806 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12807
12808 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12809 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12810 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12811
12812 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12813 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12814 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12815 flags.
12816
12817 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12818 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12819 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12820 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12821 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12822 the client connection was maintained open.
12823
12824 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012825 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012826 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12827 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12828
12829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128308.5. Session state at disconnection
12831-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012832
12833TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12834"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
128352-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12836each of which has a special meaning :
12837
12838 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12839 session to terminate :
12840
12841 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12842
12843 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12844 server explicitly refused it.
12845
12846 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12847 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12848 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12849 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012850 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12851
12852 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12853 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012854
12855 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12856 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12857 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12858 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12859 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12860
12861 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12862 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12863 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12864 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12865 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12866
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012867 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12868 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12869
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012870 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12871 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12872 backup connections when going up.
12873
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012874 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12875
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012876 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12877 send or receive data.
12878
12879 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12880 send or receive data.
12881
12882 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12883 with nothing left in the buffers.
12884
12885 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12886
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012887 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012888 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12889
12890 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12891 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12892 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12893 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12894 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12895
12896 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12897 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12898
12899 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12900 server (HTTP only).
12901
12902 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12903
12904 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12905 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12906 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12907
12908 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12909 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12910 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12911
12912 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12913
12914 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12915 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12916
12917 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12918 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12919 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12920
12921 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12922 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012923 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12924 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012925
12926 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12927 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12928 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12929 another server.
12930
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012931 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012932 server.
12933
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012934 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12935 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12936 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12937 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12938
12939 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12940 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12941 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12942 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12943
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012944 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12945 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12946 "use-server" rule).
12947
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012948 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12949
12950 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12951 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12952
12953 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12954
12955 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12956 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12957 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12958
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012959 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12960 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012961 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012962 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12963 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12964
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012965 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12966
12967 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12968 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12969
12970 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12971
12972 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12973
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012974The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12975was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012976helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12977starvation, attacks, etc...
12978
12979The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12980alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12981easier finding and understanding.
12982
12983 Flags Reason
12984
12985 -- Normal termination.
12986
12987 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12988 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12989 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12990 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12991
12992 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12993 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12994 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12995 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12996 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12997 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012998
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012999 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13000 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013001 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013002
13003 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13004 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13005 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13006
13007 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13008 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13009 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13010 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13011 the server takes too long to respond.
13012
13013 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13014 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13015 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13016 long a time to respond.
13017
13018 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13019 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13020 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13021 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13022 and the client.
13023
13024 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13025 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13026 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13027 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13028 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013029 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13030 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13031 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13032 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13033 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13034 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13035 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13036 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13037 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13038 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13039 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13040 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13041 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13042 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013043
13044 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13045 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013046 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13047 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13048 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13049 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013050
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013051 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13052 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013054 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013055 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13056 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13057 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13058 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13059 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13060
13061 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13062 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13063 503 or 504 here.
13064
13065 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13066 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13067 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13068 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13069 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13070
13071 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13072 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013073 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013074 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13075 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13076
13077 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13078 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13079 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13080 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13081 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13082 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13083 between haproxy and the server.
13084
13085 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13086 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13087 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13088 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13089 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13090 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13091 solution is to fix the application.
13092
13093 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13094 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13095 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13096 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13097 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13098 external attacks.
13099
13100 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13101 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013102 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013103 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13104 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13105
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013106 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13107 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13108 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013109 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13110 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013111
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013112 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13113 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13114 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13115 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013116 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13117 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13118 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13119 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13120 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013121
13122 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13123 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13124 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13125 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13126
13127 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13128 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13129 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13130 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13131
13132 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13133 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13134 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13135 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13136
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013137The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13138persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13139important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13140re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13141
13142 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13143
13144 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13145 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13146 set on a GET request.
13147
13148 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13149 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013150 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013151 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13152
13153 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13154 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13155 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13156
13157 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13158 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13159 already got a cookie.
13160
13161 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13162 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13163 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13164 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13165 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13166
13167 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13168 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13169 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13170
13171 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13172 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13173 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13174
13175 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13176 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13177
13178 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13179 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13180 then advertised in the response.
13181
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131838.6. Non-printable characters
13184-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013185
13186In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13187consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13188converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13189prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13190being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13191escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13192is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13193'}' when logging headers.
13194
13195Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13196issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13197containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13198
13199Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13200the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13201performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13202
13203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132048.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13205---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013206
13207Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13208achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013209section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013210cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13211the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13212the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013213locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013214not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13215user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13216a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13217wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13218
13219 Examples :
13220 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13221 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13222
13223 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13224 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13225
13226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132278.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13228---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013229
13230Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13231proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13232the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13233server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13234
13235Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13236response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013237section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013238
13239It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013240time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13241appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013242are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13243and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13244follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13245request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13246in the logs.
13247
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013248As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13249frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13250an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13251
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013252 Example :
13253 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13254 listen proxy-out
13255 mode http
13256 option httplog
13257 option logasap
13258 log global
13259 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13260
13261 # log the name of the virtual server
13262 capture request header Host len 20
13263
13264 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13265 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13266
13267 # log the beginning of the referrer
13268 capture request header Referer len 20
13269
13270 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13271 capture response header Server len 20
13272
13273 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13274 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13275
13276 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13277 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13278
13279 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13280 capture response header Via len 20
13281
13282 # log the URL location during a redirection
13283 capture response header Location len 20
13284
13285 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13286 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13287 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13288 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13289 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13290
13291 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13292 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13293 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13294 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013295 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013296
13297 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13298 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13299 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13300 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13301 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013302 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013303
13304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133058.9. Examples of logs
13306---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013307
13308These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13309them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13310reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13311
13312 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13313 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13314 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13315
13316 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13317 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13318
13319 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13320 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13321 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13322
13323 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13324 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13325
13326 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13327 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13328 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13329
13330 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013331 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013332 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13333 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13334
13335 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13336 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13337 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13338
13339 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13340 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013341 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013342 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13343 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13344 to return the 502 and not the server.
13345
13346 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013347 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013348
13349 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13350 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13351 Nothing was sent to any server.
13352
13353 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13354 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13355
13356 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13357 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13358 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13359 send a 408 return code to the client.
13360
13361 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13362 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13363
13364 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13365 5 seconds ("c----").
13366
13367 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13368 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013369 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013370
13371 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013372 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013373 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13374 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13375 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13376 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13377 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013378
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133809. Statistics and monitoring
13381----------------------------
13382
13383It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13384mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13385CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13386Unix socket.
13387
13388
133899.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013390---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013391
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013392The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013393page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13394begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13395represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13396use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13397('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13398(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13399text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13400do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13401use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013402
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013403In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13404that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13405S (Servers).
13406
13407 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13408 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13409 any name for server/listener)
13410 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13411 number queued without a server assigned.
13412 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13413 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13414 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13415 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13416 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13417 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13418 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13419 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13420 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13421 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13422 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13423 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13424 "option checkcache".
13425 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13426 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13427 - read error from the client
13428 - client timeout
13429 - client closed connection
13430 - various bad requests from the client.
13431 - request was tarpitted.
13432 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13433 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13434 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13435 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13436 active servers).
13437 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13438 Some other errors are:
13439 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13440 - failure applying filters to the response.
13441 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13442 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13443 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13444 switched away from.
13445 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13446 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13447 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13448 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13449 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13450 the server is up.)
13451 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13452 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13453 counters for each server.
13454 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13455 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13456 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13457 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13458 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13459 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13460 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13461 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13462 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13463 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13464 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13465 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13466 of times that server was selected.
13467 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13468 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13469 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13470 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13471 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13472 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013473 UNK -> unknown
13474 INI -> initializing
13475 SOCKERR -> socket error
13476 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13477 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13478 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13479 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13480 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13481 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13482 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13483 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13484 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13485 disable-on-404
13486 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13487 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13488 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013489 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13490 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13491 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13492 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13493 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13494 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13495 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13496 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13497 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13498 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13499 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13500 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13501 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13502 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13503 (inc. in eresp)
13504 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13505 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13506 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13507 (CPU/BW limit)
13508 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13509 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13510 server/backend
13511 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13512 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13513 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13514 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13515 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13516 (0 for TCP)
13517 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13518 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013519
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135219.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013522-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013523
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013524The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13525necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13526A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13527issuing commands by hand :
13528
13529 global
13530 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13531 stats timeout 2m
13532
13533It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13534the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13535never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13536situations :
13537
13538 global
13539 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13540 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13541 stats timeout 2m
13542
13543To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13544swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13545to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13546syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13547
13548 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13549 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13550
13551The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13552script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13553for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13554
13555The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13556that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13557editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13558(eg: watch a counter).
13559
13560The socket supports two operation modes :
13561 - interactive
13562 - non-interactive
13563
13564The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13565this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13566sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13567mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13568commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13569example :
13570
13571 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13572
13573The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13574entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13575for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13576sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13577"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13578after processing the last command of the same line.
13579
13580For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13581"prompt" command :
13582
13583 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13584 prompt
13585 > show info
13586 ...
13587 >
13588
13589Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13590delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13591that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13592parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013593
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013594It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13595on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13596own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013597
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013598The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13599If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13600all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13601it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13602
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013603add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013604 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13605 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13606 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13607 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013608
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013609add map <map> <key> <value>
13610 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13611 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013612 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13613 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13614 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013615
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013616clear counters
13617 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13618 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13619 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13620 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13621 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13622
13623clear counters all
13624 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13625 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13626 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13627
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013628clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013629 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13630 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13631 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013632
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013633clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013634 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13635 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13636 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013637
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013638clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13639 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13640
13641 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13642 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13643 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13644 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13645 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13646 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13647
13648 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13649
13650 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13651 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13652 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13653 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13654 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13655 the ACLs :
13656
13657 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13658 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13659 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13660 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13661 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13662 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13663
13664 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013665 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13666 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013667
13668 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013669 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013670 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013671 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13672 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13673 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13674 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013675
13676 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13677
13678 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013679 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013680 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13681 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013682 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13683 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13684 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013685
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013686del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13687 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013688 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13689 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13690 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13691 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013692
13693del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013694 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013695 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13696 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13697 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13698 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013699
13700disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013701 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13702
13703 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13704 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13705 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13706 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13707 re-enabled using enable agent.
13708
13709 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13710 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13711 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13712 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13713 otherwise unchanged.
13714
13715 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13716 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13717 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13718
13719 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13720 level "admin".
13721
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013722disable frontend <frontend>
13723 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13724 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13725 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13726 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13727 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13728 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13729 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13730 on the stats page.
13731
13732 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13733 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13734
13735 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13736 level "admin".
13737
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013738disable health <backend>/<server>
13739 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13740 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13741 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13742 agent check forces it down.
13743
13744 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13745 level "admin".
13746
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013747disable server <backend>/<server>
13748 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13749 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13750 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13751 during the maintenance.
13752
13753 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13754 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13755
13756 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013757 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013758
13759 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13760 level "admin".
13761
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013762enable agent <backend>/<server>
13763 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13764
13765 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13766 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13767
13768 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13769 level "admin".
13770
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013771enable frontend <frontend>
13772 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13773 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13774 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13775 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13776 which was disabled.
13777
13778 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13779 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13780
13781 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13782 level "admin".
13783
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013784enable health <backend>/<server>
13785 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13786 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13787
13788 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13789 level "admin".
13790
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013791enable server <backend>/<server>
13792 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13793 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13794
13795 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013796 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013797
13798 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13799 level "admin".
13800
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013801get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013802get acl <acl> <value>
13803 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13804 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13805 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13806 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13807 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013808
13809 The first two words are:
13810
13811 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13812 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13813 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13814
13815 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13816
13817 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13818
13819 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13820
13821 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13822 interpretation of the case.
13823
13824 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13825 useful with regular expressions.
13826
13827 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13828 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13829
13830 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13831 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13832 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13833
13834 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13835
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013836get weight <backend>/<server>
13837 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13838 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13839 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13840 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13841 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013842 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013843
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013844help
13845 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13846 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013847
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013848prompt
13849 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13850 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13851 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13852 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13853 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13854 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13855 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13856 command.
13857
13858quit
13859 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013860
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013861set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013862 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13863 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13864 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013865
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013866set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013867 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13868 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13869 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13870 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13871 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013872 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13873 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13874
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013875set maxconn global <maxconn>
13876 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13877 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13878 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13879 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13880 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13881 setting.
13882
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013883set rate-limit connections global <value>
13884 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13885 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13886 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13887 is passed in number of connections per second.
13888
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013889set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13890 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13891 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013892 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13893 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013894
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013895set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13896 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13897 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13898 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13899 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13900
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013901set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13902 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13903 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13904 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13905 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13906 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13907
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013908set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13909 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13910 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13911 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13912
13913set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13914 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13915 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13916 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13917
13918set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13919 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13920 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13921 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13922 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13923 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13924 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13925 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13926 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13927
13928set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13929 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13930 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13931
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013932set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13933 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13934 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13935 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13936 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13937
13938 Example:
13939 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13940 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13941 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13942 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13943
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013944set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013945 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13946 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13947 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13948 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013949 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13950 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013951
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013952set timeout cli <delay>
13953 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13954 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13955 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13956
13957set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13958 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13959 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013960 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13961 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13962 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13963 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13964 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13965 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13966 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13967 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13968 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13969 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13970 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13971 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13972 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013973
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013974show errors [<iid>]
13975 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13976 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013977 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13978 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13979 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013980
13981 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13982 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13983 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13984 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13985 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13986 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13987 are reported too.
13988
13989 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13990 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13991 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13992 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13993 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13994 code.
13995
13996 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13997 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13998 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13999 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14000 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14001 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14002 line.
14003
14004 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014005 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14006 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014007 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14008 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14009
14010 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14011 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14012 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14013 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14014 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14015 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14016 00204+ minal\r\n
14017 00211 \r\n
14018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014019 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014020 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14021 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14022 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14023 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14024 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14025 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014026
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014027show info
14028 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14029
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014030show map [<map>]
14031 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014032 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14033 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14034 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14035 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14036 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14037 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014038
14039show acl [<acl>]
14040 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014041 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14042 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14043 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14044 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14045 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014046
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014047show pools
14048 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14049 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14050 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14051 the pools.
14052
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014053show sess
14054 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014055 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14056 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14057
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014058show sess <id>
14059 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14060 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14061 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14062 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14063 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014064 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14065 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14066
14067 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14068 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014069
14070show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14071 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14072 possible to dump only selected items :
14073 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14074 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14075 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14076 for example:
14077 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14078 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14079 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14080
14081 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014082 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14083 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014084 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14085 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14086 Nbproc: 1
14087 Process_num: 1
14088 (...)
14089
14090 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14091 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14092 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14093 (...)
14094 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14095
14096 $
14097
14098 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14099 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14100 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14101 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014102 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014103
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014104show table
14105 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14106 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14107 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14108 entries currently in use.
14109
14110 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014111 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014112 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14113 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014114
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014115show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014116 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14117 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14118 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014119 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14120
14121 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14122 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14123 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14124 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14125 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14126
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014127 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14128 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14129 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14130 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14131 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14132 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14133
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014134
14135 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014136 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14137 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014138
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014139 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014140 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014141 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014142 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14143 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14144 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14145 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014146
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014147 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014148 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014149 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14150 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014151
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014152 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14153 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014154 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014155 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14156 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014157
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014158 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14159 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014160 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014161 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14162 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14163
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014164 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14165 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14166 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14167 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14168 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14169
14170 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14171 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14172 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014173 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14174 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014175 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14176 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014177
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014178shutdown frontend <frontend>
14179 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14180 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14181 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14182 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14183 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14184 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14185 once it is terminated.
14186
14187 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14188 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14189
14190 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14191 level "admin".
14192
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014193shutdown session <id>
14194 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14195 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14196 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14197 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14198 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14199 flag in the logs.
14200
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014201shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014202 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14203 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14204 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14205 'K' flag in the logs.
14206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014207/*
14208 * Local variables:
14209 * fill-column: 79
14210 * End:
14211 */